]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
gdb/ChangeLog: fix typo in an entry from 2020-11-15 (gmp-utils.c)
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
496afd17
L
1381@item unique-symbol
1382@itemx nounique-symbol
1383Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1384".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1385is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item shstk
1388Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1389to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1390Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1391
04c3a755 1392@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1394Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1395@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1396
cae64165
RM
1397@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1398@cindex visibility
1399@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1400Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1401@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1402Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1403@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1404start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1405compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1406recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1407programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1408between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item text
1411@itemx notext
1412@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1413Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1414or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1415report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1416
97a232d7
NC
1417@item undefs
1418Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1419either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1420This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1421
b0ab0693 1422@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1423@item x86-64-v2
1424@item x86-64-v3
1425@itemx x86-64-v4
1426Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1427@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1428@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1429@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1430@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1431Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
cd6d6c15
NC
1433@end table
1434
ece2d90e 1435Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1436
1437@kindex -(
1438@cindex groups of archives
1439@item -( @var{archives} -)
1440@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1441The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1442either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1443
1444The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1445references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1446the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1447archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1448object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1449would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1450they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1451resolved.
1452
1453Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1454it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1455more archives.
1456
69da35b5
NC
1457@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1458@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1459@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1460@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1461Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1462recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1463and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1464the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1465behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1466so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1467restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1468
4a43e768
AM
1469@kindex --as-needed
1470@kindex --no-as-needed
1471@item --as-needed
1472@itemx --no-as-needed
1473This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1474on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1475the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1476on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1477needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1478emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1479non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1480the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1481non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1482Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1483the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1484needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1485from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1486
e56f61be
L
1487@kindex --add-needed
1488@kindex --no-add-needed
1489@item --add-needed
1490@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1491These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1492their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1493options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1494and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1495
252b5132
RH
1496@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1497@item -assert @var{keyword}
1498This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1499
1500@kindex -Bdynamic
1501@kindex -dy
1502@kindex -call_shared
1503@item -Bdynamic
1504@itemx -dy
1505@itemx -call_shared
1506Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1507for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1508default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1509for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1510multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1511@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1512
a1ab1d2a
UD
1513@kindex -Bgroup
1514@item -Bgroup
1515Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1516section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1517object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1518@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1519only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1520
252b5132
RH
1521@kindex -Bstatic
1522@kindex -dn
1523@kindex -non_shared
1524@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1525@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1526@itemx -dn
1527@itemx -non_shared
1528@itemx -static
1529Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1530platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1531variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1532may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1533library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1534option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1535option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1536shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1537references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1538libraries.
252b5132
RH
1539
1540@kindex -Bsymbolic
1541@item -Bsymbolic
1542When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1543definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1544for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1545within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1546platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1547
40b36307
L
1548@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1549@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1550When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1551symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1552This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1553libraries.
40b36307 1554
55255dae
L
1555@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1556@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1557Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1558typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1559global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1560within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1561to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1562in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1563which support shared libraries.
1564
1565The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1566scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1567
40b36307
L
1568@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1569@item --dynamic-list-data
1570Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1571
1572@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1573@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1574Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1575is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1576
0b8a70d9
L
1577@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1578@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1579Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1580
252b5132
RH
1581@kindex --check-sections
1582@kindex --no-check-sections
1583@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1584@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1585Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1586been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1587perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1588suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1589allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1590restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1591Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1592force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1593option.
252b5132 1594
ddbb8a31
NC
1595@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1596@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1597@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1598@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1599This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1600by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1601command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1602output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1603input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1604specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1605follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1606behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1607
1608This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1609libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1610mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1611their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1612required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1613the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1614dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1615symbols.
1616
252b5132
RH
1617@cindex cross reference table
1618@kindex --cref
1619@item --cref
1620Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1621generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1622Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1623
1624The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1625easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1626sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1627symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1628definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1629where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1630symbol are listed.
252b5132 1631
5dba6f05
NA
1632@cindex ctf variables
1633@kindex --ctf-variables
1634@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1635@item --ctf-variables
1636@item --no-ctf-variables
1637The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1638types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1639table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1640conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1641usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1642@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1643The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1644
1645@cindex ctf type sharing
1646@kindex --ctf-share-types
1647@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1648Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1649
1650@table @samp
1651@item share-unconflicted
1652Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1653where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1654translation unit. This is the default.
1655
1656@item share-duplicated
1657Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1658dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1659dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1660always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1661larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1662large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1663consumer at runtime.
1664@end table
1665
4818e05f
AM
1666@cindex common allocation
1667@kindex --no-define-common
1668@item --no-define-common
1669This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1670The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1671@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1672
1673The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1674the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1675of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1676forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1677Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1678from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1679This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1680and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1681duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1682paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1683
7bdf4127
AB
1684@cindex group allocation in linker script
1685@cindex section groups
1686@cindex COMDAT
1687@kindex --force-group-allocation
1688@item --force-group-allocation
1689This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1690normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1691default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1692change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1693command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1694effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1695
252b5132 1696@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1697@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1698@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1699Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1700address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1701times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1702limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1703context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1704symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1705constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1706using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1707@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1708equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1709
54874444
AB
1710The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1711in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1712symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1713placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1714the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1715consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1716@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1717you are trying to achieve.
1718
252b5132 1719@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1720@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1721@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1722@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1723@itemx --no-demangle
1724These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1725and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1726present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1727underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1728mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1729different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1730to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1731demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1732is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1733
1734@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1735@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1736@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1737@item -I@var{file}
1738@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1739Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1740generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1741linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1742doing.
1743
9b8b325a
RF
1744@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1745@item --no-dynamic-linker
1746When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1747linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1748executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1749entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1750
a70f34c0
NC
1751@kindex --embedded-relocs
1752@item --embedded-relocs
1753This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1754that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1755is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1756targets.
1757
3f0a5f17
ME
1758@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1759@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1760Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1761in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1762
7ce691ae 1763@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1764@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1765@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1766@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1767Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1768with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1769
252b5132
RH
1770@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1771@item --force-exe-suffix
1772Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1773
1774If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1775@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1776the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1777option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1778Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1779it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1780
1781@kindex --gc-sections
1782@kindex --no-gc-sections
1783@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1784@item --gc-sections
1785@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1786Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1787targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1788performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1789@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1790collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1791implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1792
d5465ba2
AM
1793@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1794examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1795symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1796command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1797referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1798libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1799referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1800the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1801relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1802@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1803
ac69cbc6 1804This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1805@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1806specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1807@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1808command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1809
c17d87de
NC
1810@kindex --print-gc-sections
1811@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1812@cindex garbage collection
1813@item --print-gc-sections
1814@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1815List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1816printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1817collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1818default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1819be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1820line.
1821
22185505 1822@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1823@cindex garbage collection
1824@item --gc-keep-exported
1825When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1826collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1827default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1828executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1829collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1830Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1831it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1832ELF format targets.
1833
30824704
RM
1834@kindex --print-output-format
1835@cindex output format
1836@item --print-output-format
1837Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1838other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1839in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1840
3604cb1f
TG
1841@kindex --print-memory-usage
1842@cindex memory usage
1843@item --print-memory-usage
1844Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1845the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1846quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1847headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1848parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1849
1850@smallexample
1851Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1852 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1853 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1854@end smallexample
1855
252b5132
RH
1856@cindex help
1857@cindex usage
1858@kindex --help
1859@item --help
1860Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1861
ea20a7da
CC
1862@kindex --target-help
1863@item --target-help
a094d01f 1864Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1865
2509a395
SL
1866@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1867@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1868Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1869@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1870@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1871
1872Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1873written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1874inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1875file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1876@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1877output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1878@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1879
1880@smallexample
1881 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1882 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1883 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1884 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1885 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1886 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1887 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1888 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1889 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1890 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1891@end smallexample
1892
1893It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1894
1895If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1896operation.
252b5132
RH
1897
1898@cindex memory usage
1899@kindex --no-keep-memory
1900@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1901@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1902symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1903instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1904necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1905while linking a large executable.
1906
1907@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1908@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1909@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1910@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1911@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1912Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1913is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1914The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1915behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1916libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1917
97a232d7
NC
1918The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1919
aa713662
L
1920@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1921@kindex -z muldefs
1922@item --allow-multiple-definition
1923@itemx -z muldefs
1924Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1925report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1926first definition will be used.
1927
b79e8c78 1928@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1929@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1930@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1931@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1932Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1933This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1934determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1935shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1936how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1937
903249d7
NC
1938The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1939referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1940an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1941a shared library.
1942
1943The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1944libraries specified at link time are that:
1945
1946@itemize @bullet
1947@item
1948A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1949that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1950resolvable at load time.
1951@item
1952There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1953symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1954
1955The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1956select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1957architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1958appropriate memset function.
1959@end itemize
b79e8c78 1960
23ae20f5
NC
1961@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1962@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1963If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1964@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1965only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1966libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
1967``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1968undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
1969will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
1970might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1971error message will be displayed.
1972
1973The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1974switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1975
31941635
L
1976@kindex --no-undefined-version
1977@item --no-undefined-version
1978Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1979it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1980will be issued instead.
1981
3e3b46e5
PB
1982@kindex --default-symver
1983@item --default-symver
1984Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1985exported symbols.
1986
1987@kindex --default-imported-symver
1988@item --default-imported-symver
1989Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1990imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1991
252b5132
RH
1992@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1993@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1994Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1995files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1996been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1997This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1998errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1999have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2000inappropriate.
2001
fe7929ce
AM
2002@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2003@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2004Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2005library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2006
252b5132
RH
2007@kindex --no-whole-archive
2008@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2009Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2010archive files.
2011
2012@cindex output file after errors
2013@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2014@item --noinhibit-exec
2015Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2016Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2017errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2018when it issues any error whatsoever.
2019
0a9c1c8e
CD
2020@kindex -nostdlib
2021@item -nostdlib
2022Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2023command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2024(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2025
252b5132 2026@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2027@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2028@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2029@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2030file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2031@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2032object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2033object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2034should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2035usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2036name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2037list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2038command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2039this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2040@end ifclear
2041
76359541
TP
2042@kindex --out-implib
2043@item --out-implib @var{file}
2044Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2045the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2046library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2047may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2048behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2049step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2050the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2051
36af4a4e
JJ
2052@kindex -pie
2053@kindex --pic-executable
2054@item -pie
2055@itemx --pic-executable
2056@cindex position independent executables
2057Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2058ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2059libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2060address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2061normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2062defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2063
252b5132
RH
2064@kindex -qmagic
2065@item -qmagic
2066This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2067
2068@kindex -Qy
2069@item -Qy
2070This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2071
2072@kindex --relax
2073@cindex synthesizing linker
2074@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2075@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2076@item --relax
28d5f677 2077@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2078An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2079@ifset GENERIC
2080This option is only supported on a few targets.
2081@end ifset
2082@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2083@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2084@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2085@ifset XTENSA
2086@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2087@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2088@ifset M68HC11
2089@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2090@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2091@ifset NIOSII
2092@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2093@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2094@ifset POWERPC
2095@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2096@end ifset
252b5132 2097
ccd9fae5 2098On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2099global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2100addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2101synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2102instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2103
2104On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2105debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2106@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2107This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2108family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2109@end ifset
2110
ccd9fae5
NC
2111On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2112@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2113
ccd9fae5
NC
2114On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2115and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2116
252b5132
RH
2117@cindex retaining specified symbols
2118@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2119@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2120@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2121@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2122Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2123discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2124symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2125@ifset GENERIC
2126(such as VxWorks)
2127@end ifset
2128where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2129run-time memory.
2130
2131@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2132or symbols needed for relocations.
2133
2134You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2135line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2136
2137@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2138@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2139@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2140@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2141Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2142linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2143arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2144them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2145
2146The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2147are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2148description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2149in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2150have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2151
2152If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2153contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2154is defined.
252b5132 2155
ff5dcc92 2156The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2157SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2158@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2159runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2160options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2161gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2162file systems.
252b5132 2163
ff5dcc92 2164For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2165followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2166the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2167@end ifset
2168
2169@ifset GENERIC
2170@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2171@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2172@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2173When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2174happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2175of the input files.
2176
2177When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2178non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2179shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2180explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2181specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2182@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2183either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2184appearing multiple times.
2185
e680a6b6
NC
2186The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2187directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2188containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2189and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
219064-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2191
2192The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2193@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2194supported.
2195
28c309a2
NC
2196This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2197that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2198is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2199runtime linker would do.
2200
252b5132 2201The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2202libraries:
d8e4137b 2203
252b5132
RH
2204@enumerate
2205@item
ff5dcc92 2206Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2207@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2208Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2209between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2210specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2211used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2212at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2213by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2214the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2215@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2216On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2217@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2218environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2219@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2220On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2221directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2222@item
a1b8d843 2223For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2224variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2225@item
ec4eb78a
L
2226For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2227@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2228libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2229@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2230@item
252b5132
RH
2231The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2232@item
d8e4137b
NC
2233For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2234exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2235to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2236defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2237configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2238@item
2239For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2240the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2241header file.
2242@item
2243Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2244linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2245@end enumerate
2246
2247If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2248warning and continue with the link.
2249@end ifset
2250
2251@kindex -shared
2252@kindex -Bshareable
2253@item -shared
2254@itemx -Bshareable
2255@cindex shared libraries
2256Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2257and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2258shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2259undefined symbols in the link.
2260
252b5132 2261@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2262@item --sort-common
2263@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2264@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2265This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2266ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2267sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2268eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2269between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2270specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2271
2509a395
SL
2272@kindex --sort-section=name
2273@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2274This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2275patterns in the linker script.
2276
2509a395
SL
2277@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2278@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2279This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2280patterns in the linker script.
2281
a70f34c0
NC
2282@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2283@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2284This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2285.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2286post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2287
252b5132 2288@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2289@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2290Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2291each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2292size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2293
2294@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2295@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2296Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2297output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2298This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2299certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2300cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2301that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2302support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2303input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2304more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2305many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2306
2307@kindex --stats
2308@item --stats
2309Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2310as execution time and memory usage.
2311
2509a395 2312@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2313@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2314Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2315configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2316that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2317
a70f34c0
NC
2318@kindex --task-link
2319@item --task-link
2320This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2321file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2322
252b5132
RH
2323@kindex --traditional-format
2324@cindex traditional format
2325@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2326For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2327the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2328use the traditional format instead.
2329
2330@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2331For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2332symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2333full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2334@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2335trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2336combine duplicate entries.
2337
2509a395
SL
2338@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2339@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2340Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2341address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2342times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2343line.
2344@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2345for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2346@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2347should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2348sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2349
2509a395
SL
2350@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2351@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2352@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2353@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2354@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2355@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2356@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2357Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2358@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2359
2509a395
SL
2360@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2361@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2362@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2363When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2364byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2365
9d5777a3
RM
2366@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2367@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2368@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2369When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2370the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2371text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2372
0d705e9f
AM
2373@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2374@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2375@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2376When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2377model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2378
560e09e9
NC
2379@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2380@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2381Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2382values for @samp{method}:
2383
2384@table @samp
2385@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2386Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2387
2388@item report-all
da8bce14 2389Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2390
2391@item ignore-in-object-files
2392Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2393ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2394
2395@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2396Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2397ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2398when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2399libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2400command line.
2401@end table
2402
2403The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2404by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2405
2406Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2407unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2408can change this to a warning.
2409
1715a13c
L
2410@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2411@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2412@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2413@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2414Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2415supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2416the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2417argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2418
2419@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2420@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2421@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2422Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2423used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2424about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2425is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2426see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2427use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2428symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2429@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2430
7ce691ae 2431@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2432@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2433@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2434@item --warn-common
2435Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2436a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2437but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2438you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2439Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2440warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2441
2442There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2443
2444@table @samp
2445@item int i = 1;
2446A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2447file.
2448
2449@item extern int i;
2450An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2451There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2452variable somewhere.
2453
2454@item int i;
2455A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2456variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2457The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2458single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2459size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2460a definition of the same variable.
2461@end table
2462
2463The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2464Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2465just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2466encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2467a common symbol.
2468
2469@enumerate
2470@item
2471Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2472definition for the symbol.
2473@smallexample
2474@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2475 overridden by definition
2476@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2477@end smallexample
2478
2479@item
2480Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2481the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2482except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2483@smallexample
2484@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2485 overriding common
2486@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2487@end smallexample
2488
2489@item
2490Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2491@smallexample
2492@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2493 of `@var{symbol}'
2494@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2495@end smallexample
2496
2497@item
2498Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2499@smallexample
2500@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2501 overridden by larger common
2502@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2503@end smallexample
2504
2505@item
2506Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2507the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2508encountered in a different order.
2509@smallexample
2510@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2511 overriding smaller common
2512@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2513@end smallexample
2514@end enumerate
2515
2516@kindex --warn-constructors
2517@item --warn-constructors
2518Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2519object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2520detect the use of global constructors.
2521
2522@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2523@item --warn-multiple-gp
2524Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2525This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2526Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2527section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2528of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2529base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2530base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2531bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2532large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2533values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2534option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2535
2536@kindex --warn-once
2537@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2538@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2539@item --warn-once
2540Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2541which refers to it.
2542
2543@kindex --warn-section-align
2544@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2545@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2546@item --warn-section-align
2547Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2548alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2549The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2550is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2551the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2552
a6dbf402
L
2553@kindex --warn-textrel
2554@item --warn-textrel
2555Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2556or shared object.
8fdd7217 2557
a0c402a5
L
2558@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2559@item --warn-alternate-em
2560Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2561
560e09e9
NC
2562@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2563@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2564If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2565@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2566This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2567
2568@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2569@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2570This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2571it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2572
252b5132
RH
2573@kindex --whole-archive
2574@cindex including an entire archive
2575@item --whole-archive
2576For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2577@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2578in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2579files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2580library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2581library. This option may be used more than once.
2582
7ec229ce 2583Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2584about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2585Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2586list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2587your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2588
2509a395
SL
2589@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2590@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2591Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2592@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2593undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2594@var{symbol}.
2595
2596This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2597wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2598wishes to call the system function, it should call
2599@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2600
2601Here is a trivial example:
2602
2603@smallexample
2604void *
cc2f008e 2605__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2606@{
cc2f008e 2607 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2608 return __real_malloc (c);
2609@}
2610@end smallexample
2611
ff5dcc92 2612If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2613all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2614instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2615call the real @code{malloc} function.
2616
2617You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2618links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2619you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2620file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2621call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2622
4ea904ed
SH
2623Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2624internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2625@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2626@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2627
2628@smallexample
2629int
2630f (void)
2631@{
2632 return 123;
2633@}
2634
2635int
2636g (void)
2637@{
2638 return f();
2639@}
2640@end smallexample
2641
6aa29e7b 2642@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2643@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2644@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2645@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2646Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2647(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2648section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2649
e41b3a13
JJ
2650@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2651@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2652Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2653generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2654if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2655
6c1439be
L
2656@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2657@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2658@item --enable-new-dtags
2659@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2660This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2661systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2662@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2663and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2664If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2665created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2666those options are only available for ELF systems.
2667
2d643429 2668@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2669@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2670Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2671close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2672time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2673increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2674value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2675
fdc90cb4
JJ
2676@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2677@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2678Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2679@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2680new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2681the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2682hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2683but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2684
0ce398f1
L
2685@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2686@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2687@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2688@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2689@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2690@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2691@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2692@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2693On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2694compressed using zlib.
2695
2696@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2697sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2698DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2699instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2700also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2701sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2702
2703The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2704@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2705
2706Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2707sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2708for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2709uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2710
2711The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2712involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2713default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2714@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2715
35835446
JR
2716@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2717@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2718This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2719linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2720for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2721about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2722
4f9c04f7 2723Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 27241021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2725run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2726has been used.
2727
2728The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2729enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2730
c0065db7
RM
2731@kindex --build-id
2732@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2733@item --build-id
2734@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2735Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2736or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2737unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2738@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2739@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2740@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2741the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2742string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2743@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2744is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2745
2746The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2747that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2748unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2749to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2750file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2751string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2752
2753Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2754@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2755@end table
2756
0285c67d
NC
2757@c man end
2758
36f63dca 2759@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2760
0285c67d
NC
2761@c man begin OPTIONS
2762
ff5dcc92 2763The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2764the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2765normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2766use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2767@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2768like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2769symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2770object file).
2771
2772In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2773support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2774PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2775values by either a space or an equals sign.
2776
ff5dcc92 2777@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2778
2779@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2780@item --add-stdcall-alias
2781If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2782as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2783[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2784
2785@kindex --base-file
2786@item --base-file @var{file}
2787Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2788addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2789@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2790[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2791
2792@kindex --dll
2793@item --dll
2794Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2795@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2796file.
bb10df36 2797[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2798
88183869
DK
2799@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2800@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2801@item --enable-long-section-names
2802@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2803The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2804the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2805for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2806fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2807to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2808allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2809disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2810generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2811as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2812with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2813GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2814information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2815option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2816section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2817when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2818image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2819[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2820
252b5132
RH
2821@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2822@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2823@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2824@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2825If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2826do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2827only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2828resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2829undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2830@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2831to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2832warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2833import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2834to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2835feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2836@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2837mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2838[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2839
522f09cd
KT
2840@kindex --leading-underscore
2841@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2842@item --leading-underscore
2843@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2844For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2845in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2846disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2847
252b5132
RH
2848@cindex DLLs, creating
2849@kindex --export-all-symbols
2850@item --export-all-symbols
2851If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2852be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2853otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2854explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2855attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2856option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2857@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2858@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2859exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2860re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2861such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2862@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2863@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2864Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2865not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2866extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2867(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2868These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2869@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2870@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2871@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2872@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2873[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2874
2875@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2876@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2877Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2878exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2879[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2880
2927aaca
NC
2881@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2882@item --exclude-all-symbols
2883Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2884[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2885
252b5132
RH
2886@kindex --file-alignment
2887@item --file-alignment
2888Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2889file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2890512.
bb10df36 2891[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2892
2893@cindex heap size
2894@kindex --heap
2895@item --heap @var{reserve}
2896@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2897Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2898to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2899committed.
bb10df36 2900[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2901
2902@cindex image base
2903@kindex --image-base
2904@item --image-base @var{value}
2905Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2906the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2907is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2908your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2909other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2910for dlls.
bb10df36 2911[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2912
2913@kindex --kill-at
2914@item --kill-at
2915If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2916symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2917[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2918
26d2d8a2
BF
2919@kindex --large-address-aware
2920@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2921If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2922header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2923greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2924or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2925section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2926[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2927
f69a2f97
NC
2928@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2929@item --disable-large-address-aware
2930Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2931This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2932driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2933addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2934[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2935
252b5132
RH
2936@kindex --major-image-version
2937@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2938Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2939[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2940
2941@kindex --major-os-version
2942@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2943Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2944[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2945
2946@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2947@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2948Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2949[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2950
2951@kindex --minor-image-version
2952@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2953Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2954[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2955
2956@kindex --minor-os-version
2957@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2958Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2959[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2960
2961@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2962@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2963Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2964[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2965
2966@cindex DEF files, creating
2967@cindex DLLs, creating
2968@kindex --output-def
2969@item --output-def @var{file}
2970The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2971file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2972(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2973library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2974automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2975[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2976
b044cda1 2977@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2978@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2979@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2980@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2981Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2982@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2983By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2984for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2985execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2986[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2987
2988@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2989@item --disable-auto-image-base
2990Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2991user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2992default.
bb10df36 2993[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2994
2995@cindex DLLs, linking to
2996@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2997@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2998When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2999search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3000@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3001between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3002uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3003@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3004[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3005
3006@kindex --enable-auto-import
3007@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3008Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3009DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3010mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3011[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3012
3013The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3014feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3015
3016Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3017of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3018PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3019
e2a83dd0
NC
3020Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3021data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3022placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3023around a problem with consts that is described here:
3024http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3025
4d8907ac
DS
3026Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3027see this message:
0d888aac 3028
ece2d90e 3029"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3030documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3031
ece2d90e
NC
3032This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3033ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3034allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3035fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3036constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3037multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3038this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3039of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3040the warning, and exit.
3041
3042There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3043data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3044
2fa9fc65
NC
3045One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3046of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3047this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3048
c0065db7
RM
3049A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3050that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3051there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3052a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3053
3054@example
3055extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3056extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3057 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3058@end example
3059
3060or
3061
3062@example
3063extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3064extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3065 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3066@end example
3067
c0065db7 3068For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3069is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3070
3071@example
3072extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3073extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3074 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3075@end example
3076
c406afaf
NC
3077or
3078
3079@example
3080extern long long extern_ll;
3081extern_ll -->
3082 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3083@end example
3084
2fa9fc65 3085A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3086'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3087@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3088requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3089building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3090merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3091between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3092constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3093
3094Original:
3095@example
3096--foo.h
3097extern int arr[];
3098--foo.c
3099#include "foo.h"
3100void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3101 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3102@}
3103@end example
3104
3105Solution 1:
3106@example
3107--foo.h
3108extern int arr[];
3109--foo.c
3110#include "foo.h"
3111void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3112 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3113 volatile int *parr = arr;
3114 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3115@}
3116@end example
3117
3118Solution 2:
3119@example
3120--foo.h
3121/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3122#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3123 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3124#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3125#else
3126#define FOO_IMPORT
3127#endif
3128extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3129--foo.c
3130#include "foo.h"
3131void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3132 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3133@}
3134@end example
3135
c0065db7 3136A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3137library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3138for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3139functions).
b044cda1
CW
3140
3141@kindex --disable-auto-import
3142@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3143Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3144@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3145[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3146
2fa9fc65
NC
3147@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3148@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3149If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3150that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3151a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3152environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3153[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3154
3155@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3156@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3157Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3158[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3159
b044cda1
CW
3160@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3161@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3162Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3163[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3164
252b5132
RH
3165@kindex --section-alignment
3166@item --section-alignment
3167Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3168addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3169[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3170
3171@cindex stack size
3172@kindex --stack
3173@item --stack @var{reserve}
3174@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3175Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3176to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3177committed.
bb10df36 3178[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3179
3180@kindex --subsystem
3181@item --subsystem @var{which}
3182@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3183@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3184Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3185legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3186@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3187the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3188@var{which}.
bb10df36 3189[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3190
2f563b51
DK
3191The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3192of the PE file header:
3193[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3194
2d5c3743
NC
3195@kindex --high-entropy-va
3196@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3197@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3198Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3199(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3200
dc9bd8c9
HD
3201This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3202@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3203
2f563b51
DK
3204@kindex --dynamicbase
3205@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3206@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3207The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3208randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3209Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3210can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3211This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3212
3213@kindex --forceinteg
3214@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3215@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3216Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3217default.
2f563b51
DK
3218
3219@kindex --nxcompat
3220@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3221@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3222The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3223This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3224targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3225
3226@kindex --no-isolation
3227@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3228@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3229Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3230This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3231
3232@kindex --no-seh
3233@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3234@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3235The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3236this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3237
3238@kindex --no-bind
3239@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3240@itemx --disable-no-bind
3241Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3242
3243@kindex --wdmdriver
3244@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3245@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3246The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3247by default.
9d5777a3 3248
2f563b51
DK
3249@kindex --tsaware
3250@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3251@itemx --disable-tsaware
3252The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3253default.
2f563b51 3254
0cb112f7
CF
3255@kindex --insert-timestamp
3256@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3257@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3258Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3259as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3260other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3261will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3262same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3263can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3264that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3265identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3266
3267@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3268@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3269@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3270Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3271is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3272This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3273@end table
3274
0285c67d
NC
3275@c man end
3276
ac145307
BS
3277@ifset C6X
3278@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3279
3280@c man begin OPTIONS
3281
3282The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3283libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3284all executables use an index of 0.
3285
3286@table @gcctabopt
3287
3288@kindex --dsbt-size
3289@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3290This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3291or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3292entries.
3293
3294@kindex --dsbt-index
3295@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3296This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3297to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3298executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3299@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3300
fbd9ad90
PB
3301@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3302The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3303exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3304
ac145307
BS
3305@end table
3306
3307@c man end
3308@end ifset
3309
b8891f8d
AJ
3310@ifset CSKY
3311@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3312
3313@c man begin OPTIONS
3314
3315@table @gcctabopt
3316
3317@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3318@item --branch-stub
3319This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3320sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3321usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3322can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3323the compiler or assembler.
3324
3325@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3326@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3327This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3328It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3329be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3330stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3331sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3332@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3333linker should choose suitable defaults.
3334
3335@end table
3336
3337@c man end
3338@end ifset
3339
93fd0973
SC
3340@ifset M68HC11
3341@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3342
3343@c man begin OPTIONS
3344
3345The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3346memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3347
3348@table @gcctabopt
3349
3350@kindex --no-trampoline
3351@item --no-trampoline
3352This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3353is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3354instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3355
3356@kindex --bank-window
3357@item --bank-window @var{name}
3358This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3359the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3360The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3361paging and addresses within the memory window.
3362
3363@end table
3364
3365@c man end
3366@end ifset
3367
7fb9f789
NC
3368@ifset M68K
3369@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3370
3371@c man begin OPTIONS
3372
3373The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3374when linking for 68K targets.
3375
3376@table @gcctabopt
3377
3378@kindex --got
3379@item --got=@var{type}
3380This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3381@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3382@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3383Info entry for @file{ld}.
3384
3385@end table
3386
3387@c man end
3388@end ifset
3389
833794fc
MR
3390@ifset MIPS
3391@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3392
3393@c man begin OPTIONS
3394
3395The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3396generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3397linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3398
3399@table @gcctabopt
3400
3401@kindex --insn32
3402@item --insn32
3403@kindex --no-insn32
3404@itemx --no-insn32
3405These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3406generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3407or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
340832-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3409used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3410possible.
3411
8b10b0b3
MR
3412@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3413@item --ignore-branch-isa
3414@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3415@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3416These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3417transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3418accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3419is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3420instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3421equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3422calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3423a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3424an error.
3425
3734320d
MF
3426@kindex --compact-branches
3427@item --compact-branches
3428@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3429@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3430These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3431in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3432
833794fc
MR
3433@end table
3434
3435@c man end
3436@end ifset
3437
fa1477dc
SC
3438
3439@ifset PDP11
3440@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3441
3442@c man begin OPTIONS
3443
3444For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3445produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3446for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3447targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3448defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3449here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3450
3451@table @gcctabopt
3452
3453@kindex -N
3454@item -N
3455@kindex --omagic
3456@itemx --omagic
3457
3458Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3459indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3460shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3461writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3462the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3463programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3464from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3465
3466@kindex -n
3467@item -n
3468@kindex --nmagic
3469@itemx --nmagic
3470
3471Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3472indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3473be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3474file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3475byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3476a @emph{pure executable} format.
3477
3478@kindex -z
3479@item -z
3480@kindex --imagic
3481@itemx --imagic
3482
3483Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3484indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3485data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3486instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3487larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3488to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3489shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3490option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3491and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3492this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3493executable} format.
3494
3495@kindex --no-omagic
3496@item --no-omagic
3497
3498Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3499
3500@end table
3501
3502@c man end
3503@end ifset
3504
252b5132
RH
3505@ifset UsesEnvVars
3506@node Environment
3507@section Environment Variables
3508
0285c67d
NC
3509@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3510
560e09e9 3511You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3512@ifclear SingleFormat
3513@code{GNUTARGET},
3514@end ifclear
3515@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3516
36f63dca 3517@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3518@kindex GNUTARGET
3519@cindex default input format
3520@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3521use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3522of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3523@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3524of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3525attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3526this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3527there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3528object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3529BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3530in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3531@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3532
3533@kindex LDEMULATION
3534@cindex default emulation
3535@cindex emulation, default
3536@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3537@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3538behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3539available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3540the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3541variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3542linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3543
3544@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3545@cindex demangling, default
3546Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3547@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3548default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3549a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3550may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3551options.
3552
0285c67d
NC
3553@c man end
3554@end ifset
3555
252b5132
RH
3556@node Scripts
3557@chapter Linker Scripts
3558
3559@cindex scripts
3560@cindex linker scripts
3561@cindex command files
3562Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3563written in the linker command language.
3564
3565The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3566the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3567the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3568more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3569direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3570described below.
3571
3572The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3573yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3574linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3575to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3576such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3577
3578You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3579line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3580default linker script.
3581
3582You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3583to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3584Linker Scripts}.
3585
3586@menu
3587* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3588* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3589* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3590* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3591* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3592* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3593* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3594* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3595* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3596* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3597* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3598@end menu
3599
3600@node Basic Script Concepts
3601@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3602@cindex linker script concepts
3603We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3604describe the linker script language.
3605
3606The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3607file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3608@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3609The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3610purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3611among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3612section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3613in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3614
3615Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3616also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3617contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3618the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3619A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3620area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3621loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3622which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3623of debugging information.
3624
3625Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3626first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3627the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3628@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3629section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3630same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3631is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3632(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3633based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3634RAM address would be the VMA.
3635
3636You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3637program with the @samp{-h} option.
3638
3639Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3640@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3641has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3642information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3643will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3644static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3645referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3646
3647You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3648program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3649option.
3650
3651@node Script Format
3652@section Linker Script Format
3653@cindex linker script format
3654Linker scripts are text files.
3655
3656You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3657either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3658symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3659generally ignored.
3660
3661Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3662If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3663otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3664double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3665file name.
3666
3667You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3668@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3669to whitespace.
3670
3671@node Simple Example
3672@section Simple Linker Script Example
3673@cindex linker script example
3674@cindex example of linker script
3675Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3676
3677The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3678@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3679memory layout of the output file.
3680
3681The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3682describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3683code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3684@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3685Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3686your input files.
3687
3688For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36890x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3690linker script which will do that:
3691@smallexample
3692SECTIONS
3693@{
3694 . = 0x10000;
3695 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3696 . = 0x8000000;
3697 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3698 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3699@}
3700@end smallexample
3701
3702You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3703followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3704descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3705
252b5132
RH
3706The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3707sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3708counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3709other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3710current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3711incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3712@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3713
3714The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3715required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3716after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3717which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3718wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3719means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3720
3721Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3722@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3723@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3724
3725The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3726the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3727at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3728output section, the value of the location counter will be
3729@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3730effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3731immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3732
3733The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3734alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3735example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3736sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3737may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3738sections.
3739
3740That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3741
3742@node Simple Commands
3743@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3744@cindex linker script simple commands
3745In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3746
3747@menu
3748* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3749* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3750@ifclear SingleFormat
3751* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3752@end ifclear
3753
4a93e180 3754* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3755* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3756@end menu
3757
3758@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3759@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3760@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3761@cindex start of execution
3762@cindex first instruction
3763@cindex entry point
3764The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3765point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3766entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3767@smallexample
3768ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3769@end smallexample
3770
3771There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3772entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3773stopping when one of them succeeds:
3774@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3775@item
252b5132 3776the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3777@item
252b5132 3778the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3779@item
a094d01f 3780the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3781targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3782check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3783@item
252b5132 3784the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3785@item
252b5132
RH
3786The address @code{0}.
3787@end itemize
3788
3789@node File Commands
36f63dca 3790@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3791@cindex linker script file commands
3792Several linker script commands deal with files.
3793
3794@table @code
3795@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3796@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3797@cindex including a linker script
3798Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3799be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3800with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
380110 levels deep.
3802
4006703d
NS
3803You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3804@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3805
252b5132
RH
3806@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3807@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3808@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3809@cindex input files in linker scripts
3810@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3811@cindex linker script input object files
3812The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3813in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3814
3815For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3816a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3817then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3818
3819In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3820script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3821
e3f2db7f
AO
3822In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3823with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3824located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3825for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3826@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3827filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3828@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3829
3830If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3831the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3832found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3833not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3834path.
252b5132 3835
ff5dcc92 3836If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3837name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3838@samp{-l}.
3839
3840When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3841files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3842script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3843
3844@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3845@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3846@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3847@cindex grouping input files
3848The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3849files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3850new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3851in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3852
b717d30e
JJ
3853@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3854@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3855@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3856This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3857commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3858as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3859with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3860when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3861@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3862and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3863setting afterwards.
3864
252b5132
RH
3865@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3866@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3867@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3868The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3869@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3870@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3871Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3872precedence.
3873
3874You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3875output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3876
3877@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3878@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3879@cindex library search path in linker script
3880@cindex archive search path in linker script
3881@cindex search path in linker script
3882The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3883@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3884@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3885on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3886are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3887the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3888
3889@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3890@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3891@cindex first input file
3892The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3893that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3894though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3895when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3896first file.
3897@end table
3898
3899@ifclear SingleFormat
3900@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3901@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3902A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3903
3904@table @code
3905@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3906@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3907@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3908@cindex output file format in linker script
3909The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3910output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3911exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3912(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3913line option takes precedence.
3914
3915You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3916formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3917This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3918desired endianness.
3919
3920If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3921will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3922output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3923used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3924
3925For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3926command:
3927@smallexample
3928OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3929@end smallexample
3930This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3931@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3932option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3933format.
3934
3935@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3936@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3937@cindex input file format in linker script
3938The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3939files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3940This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3941(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3942is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3943command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3944@end table
3945@end ifclear
3946
4a93e180
NC
3947@node REGION_ALIAS
3948@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3949@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3950@cindex region alias
3951@cindex region names
3952
3953Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3954@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3955
3956@smallexample
3957REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3958@end smallexample
3959
3960The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3961memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3962to memory regions. An example follows.
3963
3964Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3965memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3966that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3967non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3968access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3969read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3970sections:
3971
3972@itemize @bullet
3973@item
3974@code{.text} program code;
3975@item
3976@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3977@item
3978@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3979@item
3980@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3981@end itemize
3982
3983The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3984part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3985output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3986systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3987@code{C}:
3988@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3989@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3990@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3991@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3992@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3993@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3994@end multitable
3995The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3996loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3997the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3998the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3999
4000The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4001includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4002memory layout:
4003@smallexample
4004INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4005
4006SECTIONS
4007 @{
4008 .text :
4009 @{
4010 *(.text)
4011 @} > REGION_TEXT
4012 .rodata :
4013 @{
4014 *(.rodata)
4015 rodata_end = .;
4016 @} > REGION_RODATA
4017 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4018 @{
4019 data_start = .;
4020 *(.data)
4021 @} > REGION_DATA
4022 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4023 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4024 .bss :
4025 @{
4026 *(.bss)
4027 @} > REGION_BSS
4028 @}
4029@end smallexample
4030
4031Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4032regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4033variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4034@table @code
4035@item A
4036Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4037@smallexample
4038MEMORY
4039 @{
4040 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4041 @}
4042
4043REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4044REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4045REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4046REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4047@end smallexample
4048@item B
4049Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4050into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4051@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4052@smallexample
4053MEMORY
4054 @{
4055 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4056 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4057 @}
4058
4059REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4060REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4061REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4062REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4063@end smallexample
4064@item C
4065Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4066@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4067initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4068system start into the @code{RAM}.
4069@smallexample
4070MEMORY
4071 @{
4072 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4073 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4074 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4075 @}
4076
4077REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4078REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4079REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4080REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4081@end smallexample
4082@end table
4083
4084It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4085@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4086necessary:
4087@smallexample
4088#include <string.h>
4089
4090extern char data_start [];
4091extern char data_size [];
4092extern char data_load_start [];
4093
4094void copy_data(void)
4095@{
4096 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4097 @{
4098 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4099 @}
4100@}
4101@end smallexample
4102
252b5132 4103@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4104@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4105There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4106
4107@table @code
4108@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4109@kindex ASSERT
4110@cindex assertion in linker script
4111Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4112with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4113
fd1c4238
NC
4114Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4115take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4116inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4117for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4118symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4119
4120@smallexample
4121 .stack :
4122 @{
4123 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4124 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4125 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4126 @}
4127@end smallexample
4128
4129will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4130PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4131can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4132
4133@smallexample
4134 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4135 .stack :
4136 @{
4137 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4138 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4139 @}
4140@end smallexample
4141
4142will work.
4143
252b5132
RH
4144@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4145@kindex EXTERN
4146@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4147Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4148symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4149modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4150each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4151command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4152
4153@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4154@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4155@cindex common allocation in linker script
4156This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4157to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4158output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4159
4818e05f
AM
4160@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4161@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4162@cindex common allocation in linker script
4163This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4164command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4165to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4166
7bdf4127
AB
4167@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4168@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4169@cindex group allocation in linker script
4170@cindex section groups
4171@cindex COMDAT
4172This command has the same effect as the
4173@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4174@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4175and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4176specified (@samp{-r}).
4177
53d25da6
AM
4178@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4179@kindex INSERT
4180@cindex insert user script into default script
4181This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4182augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4183inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4184@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4185default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4186sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4187linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4188insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4189linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4190default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4191of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4192to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4193is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4194
4195@smallexample
4196SECTIONS
4197@{
4198 OVERLAY :
4199 @{
4200 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4201 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4202 @}
4203@}
4204INSERT AFTER .text;
4205@end smallexample
4206
252b5132
RH
4207@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4208@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4209@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4210This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4211references among certain output sections.
4212
4213In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4214using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4215will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4216errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4217a function defined in the other section.
4218
4219The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4220@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4221an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4222@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4223names.
4224
cdf96953
MF
4225@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4226@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4227@cindex cross references
4228This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4229references to one section from a list of other sections.
4230
4231The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4232output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4233a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4234there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4235must never call back.
4236
4237The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4238The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4239If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4240the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4241status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4242names, not input section names.
4243
252b5132
RH
4244@ifclear SingleFormat
4245@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4246@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4247@cindex machine architecture
4248@cindex architecture
4249Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4250of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4251architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4252the @samp{-f} option.
4253@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4254
4255@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4256@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4257This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4258@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4259in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4260@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4261@end table
4262
4263@node Assignments
4264@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4265@cindex assignment in scripts
4266@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4267@cindex variables, defining
4268You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4269the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4270
4271@menu
4272* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4273* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4274* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4275* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4276* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4277@end menu
4278
4279@node Simple Assignments
4280@subsection Simple Assignments
4281
4282You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4283
4284@table @code
4285@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4286@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4287@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4288@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4289@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4290@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4291@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4292@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4293@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4294@end table
4295
4296The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4297@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4298defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4299
4300The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4301may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4302
4303The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4304
4305Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4306
4307You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4308statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4309section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4310
4311The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4312expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4313
4314Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4315assignments may be used:
4316
4317@smallexample
4318floating_point = 0;
4319SECTIONS
4320@{
4321 .text :
4322 @{
4323 *(.text)
4324 _etext = .;
4325 @}
156e34dd 4326 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4327 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4328@}
4329@end smallexample
4330@noindent
4331In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4332zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4333the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4334defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4335upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4336
eb8476a6
MR
4337@node HIDDEN
4338@subsection HIDDEN
4339@cindex HIDDEN
4340For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4341exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4342
4343Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4344@code{HIDDEN}:
4345
4346@smallexample
4347HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4348SECTIONS
4349@{
4350 .text :
4351 @{
4352 *(.text)
4353 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4354 @}
4355 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4356 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4357@}
4358@end smallexample
4359@noindent
4360In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4361
252b5132
RH
4362@node PROVIDE
4363@subsection PROVIDE
4364@cindex PROVIDE
4365In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4366only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4367the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4368@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4369@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4370@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4371@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4372@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4373
4374Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4375@smallexample
4376SECTIONS
4377@{
4378 .text :
4379 @{
4380 *(.text)
4381 _etext = .;
4382 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4383 @}
4384@}
4385@end smallexample
4386
4387In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4388underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4389the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4390underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4391If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4392linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4393
b0daac83
NC
4394Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4395defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4396that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4397when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4398@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4399
7af8e998
L
4400@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4401@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4402@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4403Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4404hidden and won't be exported.
4405
73ae6183
NC
4406@node Source Code Reference
4407@subsection Source Code Reference
4408
4409Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4410intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4411a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4412symbol that does not have a value.
4413
4414Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4415transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4416stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4417prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4418mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4419of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4420variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4421linker script variable might be referred to as:
4422
4423@smallexample
4424 extern int foo;
4425@end smallexample
4426
4427But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4428
4429@smallexample
4430 _foo = 1000;
4431@end smallexample
4432
4433In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4434transformation has taken place.
4435
4436When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4437things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4438in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4439second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4440table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4441contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4442value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4443
4444@smallexample
4445 int foo = 1000;
4446@end smallexample
4447
10bf6894 4448creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4449holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4450number 1000 is initially stored.
4451
4452When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4453first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4454memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4455So:
4456
4457@smallexample
4458 foo = 1;
4459@end smallexample
4460
4461looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4462associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4463address. Whereas:
4464
4465@smallexample
4466 int * a = & foo;
4467@end smallexample
4468
10bf6894 4469looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4470and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4471the variable @samp{a}.
4472
4473Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4474the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4475an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4476
4477@smallexample
4478 foo = 1000;
4479@end smallexample
4480
4481creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4482the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4483address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4484linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4485access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4486
4487Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4488you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4489use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4490section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4491linker script contains these declarations:
4492
4493@smallexample
4494@group
4495 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4496 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4497 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4498@end group
4499@end smallexample
4500
4501Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4502
4503@smallexample
4504@group
4505 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4506
73ae6183
NC
4507 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4508@end group
4509@end smallexample
4510
4511Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4512Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4513arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4514
4515@smallexample
4516@group
4517 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4518
4519 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4520@end group
4521@end smallexample
4522
4523Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4524operators.
73ae6183 4525
252b5132 4526@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4527@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4528@kindex SECTIONS
4529The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4530into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4531
4532The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4533@smallexample
4534SECTIONS
4535@{
4536 @var{sections-command}
4537 @var{sections-command}
4538 @dots{}
4539@}
4540@end smallexample
4541
4542Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4543
4544@itemize @bullet
4545@item
4546an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4547@item
4548a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4549@item
4550an output section description
4551@item
4552an overlay description
4553@end itemize
4554
4555The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4556@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4557those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4558understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4559the layout of the output file.
4560
4561Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4562below.
4563
4564If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4565linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4566section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4567input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4568example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4569in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4570
4571@menu
4572* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4573* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4574* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4575* Input Section:: Input section description
4576* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4577* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4578* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4579* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4580* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4581@end menu
4582
4583@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4584@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4585The full description of an output section looks like this:
4586@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4587@group
7e7d5768 4588@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4589 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4590 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4591 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4592 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4593 @{
4594 @var{output-section-command}
4595 @var{output-section-command}
4596 @dots{}
abc9061b 4597 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4598@end group
4599@end smallexample
4600
4601Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4602
4603The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4604name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4605The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4606the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4607The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4608
4609Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4610
4611@itemize @bullet
4612@item
4613a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4614@item
4615an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4616@item
4617data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4618@item
4619a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4620@end itemize
4621
4622@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4623@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4624@cindex name, section
4625@cindex section name
4626The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4627meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4628support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4629must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4630example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4631output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4632names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4633quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4634characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4635commas must be quoted.
4636
4637The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4638Discarding}.
4639
4640@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4641@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4642@cindex address, section
4643@cindex section address
4644The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4645address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4646is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4647
4648If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4649section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4650to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4651alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4652contained within the output section.
4653
4654The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4655
4656@itemize @bullet
4657@item
4658If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4659is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4660in that region.
4661
4662@item
4663If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4664regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4665section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4666be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4667
4668@item
4669If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4670the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4671counter.
4672@end itemize
4673
4674@noindent
4675For example:
4676
252b5132
RH
4677@smallexample
4678.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4679@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4680
252b5132
RH
4681@noindent
4682and
ea5cae92 4683
252b5132
RH
4684@smallexample
4685.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4686@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4687
252b5132
RH
4688@noindent
4689are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4690@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4691counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4692counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4693input sections.
252b5132
RH
4694
4695The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4696For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4697so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4698do something like this:
4699@smallexample
4700.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4701@end smallexample
4702@noindent
4703This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4704aligned upward to the specified value.
4705
4706Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4707location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4708sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4709
4710@node Input Section
36f63dca 4711@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4712@cindex input sections
4713@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4714The most common output section command is an input section description.
4715
4716The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4717You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4718in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4719map the input files into your memory layout.
4720
4721@menu
4722* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4723* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4724* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4725* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4726* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4727@end menu
4728
4729@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4730@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4731@cindex input section basics
4732An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4733by a list of section names in parentheses.
4734
4735The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4736describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4737
4738The most common input section description is to include all input
4739sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4740include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4741@smallexample
4742*(.text)
4743@end smallexample
4744@noindent
18625d54 4745Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4746@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4747of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4748match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4749example:
252b5132 4750@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4751EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4752@end smallexample
4753@noindent
4754will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4755and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4756placed inside the section list, for example:
4757@smallexample
b4346c09 4758*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4759@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4760@noindent
4761The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4762two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4763more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4764
4765There are two ways to include more than one section:
4766@smallexample
4767*(.text .rdata)
4768*(.text) *(.rdata)
4769@end smallexample
4770@noindent
4771The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4772@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4773first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4774they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4775@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4776@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4777
8f1732fc
AB
4778When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4779is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4780immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4781@smallexample
4782*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4783@end smallexample
4784@noindent
4785will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4786@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4787from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4788exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4789could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4790@smallexample
4791*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4792@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4793@noindent
4794Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4795before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4796all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4797@smallexample
4798EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4799@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4800
252b5132
RH
4801You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4802You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4803needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4804@smallexample
4805data.o(.data)
4806@end smallexample
4807
ae17ab41
CM
4808To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4809of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4810
4811Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4812
4813@smallexample
4814@group
4815SECTIONS @{
4816 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4817 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4818@}
4819@end group
4820@end smallexample
4821
4822In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4823input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4824@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4825@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4826whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4827
967928e9
AM
4828You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4829matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4830with no whitespace around the colon.
4831
4832@table @samp
4833@item archive:file
4834matches file within archive
4835@item archive:
4836matches the whole archive
4837@item :file
4838matches file but not one in an archive
4839@end table
4840
4841Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4842wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4843single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4844@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4845within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4846also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4847other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4848from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4849command.
4850
252b5132
RH
4851If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4852the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4853commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4854@smallexample
4855data.o
4856@end smallexample
4857
967928e9
AM
4858When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4859and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4860characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4861name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4862did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4863though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4864@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4865the archive search path.
4866
4867@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4868@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4869@cindex input section wildcards
4870@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4871@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4872@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4873In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4874name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4875
4876The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4877pattern for the file name.
4878
4879The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4880
4881@table @samp
4882@item *
4883matches any number of characters
4884@item ?
4885matches any single character
4886@item [@var{chars}]
4887matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4888character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4889@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4890@item \
4891quotes the following character
4892@end table
4893
4894When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4895will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4896Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4897exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4898@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4899a @samp{/} character.
4900
4901File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4902specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4903does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4904
4905If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4906appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4907will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4908sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4909@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4910@smallexample
4911.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4912.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4913@end smallexample
4914
bcaa7b3e 4915@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4916Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4917in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4918this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4919pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4920@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4921into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4922
bcaa7b3e 4923@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4924@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4925@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4926alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4927alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4928needed.
bcaa7b3e 4929
02ecc8e9 4930@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4931@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4932@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4933numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4934section name before placing them in the output file. In
4935@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4936the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4937@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4938
bcaa7b3e
L
4939@cindex SORT
4940@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4941
4942When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4943can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4944
4945@enumerate
4946@item
4947@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4948It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4949sections have the same name.
4950@item
4951@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4952It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4953sections have the same alignment.
4954@item
c0065db7 4955@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4956treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4957@item
4958@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4959is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4960@item
4961All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4962@end enumerate
4963
a05a5b64 4964When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4965section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4966takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4967
4968If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4969command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4970treated as nested sorting command.
4971
4972@enumerate
4973@item
4974@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4975@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4976@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4977@item
4978@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4979@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4980@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4981@end enumerate
4982
4983If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4984command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4985
eda680f8 4986@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4987@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4988section sorting option.
4989
252b5132
RH
4990If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4991@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4992precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4993
4994This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4995files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4996sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4997The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4998with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4999linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5000@smallexample
5001@group
5002SECTIONS @{
5003 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5004 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5005 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5006 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5007@}
5008@end group
5009@end smallexample
5010
5011@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5012@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5013@cindex common symbol placement
5014@cindex uninitialized data placement
5015A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5016file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5017linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5018named @samp{COMMON}.
5019
5020You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5021other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5022particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5023input files are placed in another section.
5024
5025In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5026@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5027@smallexample
5028.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5029@end smallexample
5030
5031@cindex scommon section
5032@cindex small common symbols
5033Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5034example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5035symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5036different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5037the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5038symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5039to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5040locations.
5041
5042@cindex [COMMON]
5043You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5044notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5045@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5046
5047@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5048@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5049@cindex KEEP
5050@cindex garbage collection
5051When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5052it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5053This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5054with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5055@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5056
5057@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5058@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5059The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5060to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5061start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5062@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5063follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5064@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5065@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5066All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5067files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5068
5069@smallexample
5070@group
5071SECTIONS @{
5072 outputa 0x10000 :
5073 @{
5074 all.o
5075 foo.o (.input1)
5076 @}
36f63dca
NC
5077@end group
5078@group
252b5132
RH
5079 outputb :
5080 @{
5081 foo.o (.input2)
5082 foo1.o (.input1)
5083 @}
36f63dca
NC
5084@end group
5085@group
252b5132
RH
5086 outputc :
5087 @{
5088 *(.input1)
5089 *(.input2)
5090 @}
5091@}
5092@end group
a1ab1d2a 5093@end smallexample
252b5132 5094
cbd0eecf
L
5095If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5096and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5097automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5098__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5099indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5100respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5101C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5102
252b5132 5103@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5104@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5105@cindex data
5106@cindex section data
5107@cindex output section data
5108@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5109@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5110@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5111@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5112@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5113You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5114@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5115an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5116parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5117value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5118counter.
5119
5120The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5121store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5122bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5123stored.
5124
5125For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5126of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5127@smallexample
5128BYTE(1)
5129LONG(addr)
5130@end smallexample
5131
5132When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5133same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5134target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5135@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5136@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5137
5138If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5139which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5140When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5141true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5142endianness of the first input object file.
5143
36f63dca 5144Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5145between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5146@smallexample
5147SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5148@end smallexample
5149whereas this will work:
5150@smallexample
5151SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5152@end smallexample
5153
252b5132
RH
5154@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5155@cindex holes, filling
5156@cindex unspecified memory
5157You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5158current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5159otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5160gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5161with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5162necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5163point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5164than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5165different parts of an output section.
5166
5167This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5168value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5169@smallexample
563e308f 5170FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5171@end smallexample
5172
5173The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5174section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5175part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5176entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5177precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5178expression.
252b5132
RH
5179
5180@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5181@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5182There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5183commands.
5184
5185@table @code
5186@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5187@cindex input filename symbols
5188@cindex filename symbols
5189@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5190The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5191The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5192file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5193the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5194
5195This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5196normally used for any other object file format.
5197
5198@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5199@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5200@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5201@item CONSTRUCTORS
5202When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5203unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5204destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5205arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5206automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5207For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5208linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5209@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5210ignored for other object file formats.
5211
5212The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5213constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5214Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5215the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5216first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5217of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5218compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5219formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5220@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5221the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5222destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5223@code{exit}.
5224
5225For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5226arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5227addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5228and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5229linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5230runtime code expects to see.
5231
5232@smallexample
5233 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5234 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5235 *(.ctors)
5236 LONG(0)
5237 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5238 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5239 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5240 *(.dtors)
5241 LONG(0)
5242 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5243@end smallexample
5244
5245If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5246which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5247are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5248are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5249command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5250@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5251@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5252@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5253
5254Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5255and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5256need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5257scripts.
5258
5259@end table
5260
5261@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5262@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5263@cindex discarding sections
5264@cindex sections, discarding
5265@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5266The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5267This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5268may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5269@smallexample
49c13adb 5270.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5271@end smallexample
5272@noindent
5273will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5274@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5275sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5276space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5277too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5278space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5279@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5280@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5281This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5282
a0976ea4 5283The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5284on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5285symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5286the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5287section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5288
5289@cindex /DISCARD/
5290The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5291input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5292section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5293
a2e098c3
NC
5294Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5295discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5296members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5297Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5298
252b5132 5299@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5300@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5301@cindex output section attributes
5302We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5303like this:
0c71d759 5304
252b5132 5305@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5306@group
7e7d5768 5307@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5308 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5309 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5310 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5311 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5312 @{
5313 @var{output-section-command}
5314 @var{output-section-command}
5315 @dots{}
562d3460 5316 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5317@end group
5318@end smallexample
0c71d759 5319
252b5132
RH
5320We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5321@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5322remaining section attributes.
5323
a1ab1d2a 5324@menu
252b5132
RH
5325* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5326* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5327* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5328* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5329* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5330* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5331* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5332* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5333@end menu
5334
5335@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5336@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5337Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5338parentheses. The following types are defined:
5339
5340@table @code
5341@item NOLOAD
5342The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5343loaded into memory when the program is run.
5344@item DSECT
5345@itemx COPY
5346@itemx INFO
5347@itemx OVERLAY
5348These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5349rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5350marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5351section when the program is run.
5352@end table
5353
5354@kindex NOLOAD
5355@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5356@cindex loading, preventing
5357The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5358the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5359the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5360@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5361need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5362@smallexample
5363@group
5364SECTIONS @{
5365 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5366 @dots{}
5367@}
5368@end group
5369@end smallexample
5370
5371@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5372@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5373@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5374@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5375@cindex load address
5376@cindex section load address
5377Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5378@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5379@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5380specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5381address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5382
ea5cae92
NC
5383The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5384specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5385takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5386load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5387region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5388
5389If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5390section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5391load address:
5392
5393@itemize @bullet
5394@item
5395If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5396the LMA address as well.
5397
5398@item
5399If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5400
5401@item
5402Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5403with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5404section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5405VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5406the last section in the located region.
5407
5408@item
5409If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5410that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5411
5412@item
5413If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5414section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5415@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5416
5417@cindex ROM initialized data
5418@cindex initialized data in ROM
5419This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5420example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5421called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5422@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5423even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5424uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5425defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5426counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5427
5428@smallexample
5429@group
5430SECTIONS
5431 @{
5432 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5433 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5434 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5435 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5436 .bss 0x3000 :
5437 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5438@}
5439@end group
5440@end smallexample
5441
5442The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5443this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5444the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5445how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5446script.
5447
5448@smallexample
5449@group
5450extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5451char *src = &_etext;
5452char *dst = &_data;
5453
ea5cae92
NC
5454/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5455while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5456 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5457
ea5cae92 5458/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5459for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5460 *dst = 0;
5461@end group
5462@end smallexample
5463
bbf115d3
L
5464@node Forced Output Alignment
5465@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5466@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5467@cindex forcing output section alignment
5468@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5469You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5470alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5471intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5472
7e7d5768
AM
5473@node Forced Input Alignment
5474@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5475@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5476@cindex forcing input section alignment
5477@cindex input section alignment
5478You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5479SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5480sections, whether larger or smaller.
5481
0c71d759
NC
5482@node Output Section Constraint
5483@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5484@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5485@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5486@cindex constraints on output sections
5487You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5488of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5489read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5490@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5491
252b5132 5492@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5493@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5494@kindex >@var{region}
5495@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5496@cindex memory regions and sections
5497You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5498using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5499
5500Here is a simple example:
5501@smallexample
5502@group
5503MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5504SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5505@end group
5506@end smallexample
5507
5508@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5509@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5510@kindex :@var{phdr}
5511@cindex section, assigning to program header
5512@cindex program headers and sections
5513You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5514using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5515one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5516assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5517@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5518linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5519
5520Here is a simple example:
5521@smallexample
5522@group
5523PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5524SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5525@end group
5526@end smallexample
5527
5528@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5529@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5530@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5531@cindex section fill pattern
5532@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5533You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5534@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5535(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5536within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5537alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5538necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5539of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5540an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5541fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5542other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5543pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5544expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5545
5546You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5547output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5548
5549Here is a simple example:
5550@smallexample
5551@group
563e308f 5552SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5553@end group
5554@end smallexample
5555
5556@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5557@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5558@kindex OVERLAY
5559@cindex overlays
5560An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5561are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5562the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5563copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5564required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5565can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5566than another.
5567
5568Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5569@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5570output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5571command is as follows:
5572@smallexample
5573@group
5574OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5575 @{
5576 @var{secname1}
5577 @{
5578 @var{output-section-command}
5579 @var{output-section-command}
5580 @dots{}
5581 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5582 @var{secname2}
5583 @{
5584 @var{output-section-command}
5585 @var{output-section-command}
5586 @dots{}
5587 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5588 @dots{}
abc9061b 5589 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5590@end group
5591@end smallexample
5592
5593Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5594section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5595section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5596those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5597except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5598sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5599
abc9061b
CC
5600The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5601the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5602
252b5132
RH
5603The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5604addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5605memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5606whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5607and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5608and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5609
56dd11f0
NC
5610If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5611references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5612the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5613sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5614@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5615
5616For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5617provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5618defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5619@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5620the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5621within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5622symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5623
5624At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5625the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5626
5627Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5628@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5629@smallexample
5630@group
5631 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5632 @{
5633 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5634 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5635 @}
5636@end group
5637@end smallexample
5638@noindent
5639This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5640address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5641@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5642following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5643@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5644@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5645
5646C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5647like the following.
5648
5649@smallexample
5650@group
5651 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5652 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5653 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5654@end group
5655@end smallexample
5656
5657Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5658everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5659example could have been written identically as follows.
5660
5661@smallexample
5662@group
5663 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5664 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5665 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5666 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5667 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5668 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5669 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5670@end group
5671@end smallexample
5672
5673@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5674@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5675@kindex MEMORY
5676@cindex memory regions
5677@cindex regions of memory
5678@cindex allocating memory
5679@cindex discontinuous memory
5680The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5681memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5682
5683The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5684memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5685may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5686can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5687set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5688regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5689around to fit into the available regions.
5690
127fcdff
AB
5691A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5692however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5693specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5694@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5695@smallexample
5696@group
a1ab1d2a 5697MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5698 @{
5699 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5700 @dots{}
5701 @}
5702@end group
5703@end smallexample
5704
5705The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5706region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5707Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5708with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5709must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5710add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5711command.
252b5132
RH
5712
5713@cindex memory region attributes
5714The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5715whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5716not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5717@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5718section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5719the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5720them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5721
5722The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5723@table @samp
5724@item R
5725Read-only section
5726@item W
5727Read/write section
5728@item X
5729Executable section
5730@item A
5731Allocatable section
5732@item I
5733Initialized section
5734@item L
5735Same as @samp{I}
5736@item !
c09e9a8c 5737Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5738@end table
5739
81c688d5 5740If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5741@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5742attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5743unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5744not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5745string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5746or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5747the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5748
5749@kindex ORIGIN =
5750@kindex o =
5751@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5752The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5753the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5754cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5755abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5756@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5757
5758@kindex LENGTH =
5759@kindex len =
5760@kindex l =
5761The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5762region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5763be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5764@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5765
5766In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5767available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5768and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5769linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5770is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5771or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5772explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5773region.
5774
5775@smallexample
5776@group
a1ab1d2a 5777MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5778 @{
5779 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5780 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5781 @}
5782@end group
5783@end smallexample
5784
5785Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5786specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5787@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5788a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5789output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5790was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5791the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5792output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5793region, the linker will issue an error message.
5794
3ec57632 5795It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5796expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5797@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5798
5799@smallexample
5800@group
c0065db7 5801 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5802@end group
5803@end smallexample
5804
252b5132
RH
5805@node PHDRS
5806@section PHDRS Command
5807@kindex PHDRS
5808@cindex program headers
5809@cindex ELF program headers
5810@cindex program segments
5811@cindex segments, ELF
5812The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5813@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5814loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5815program with the @samp{-p} option.
5816
5817When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5818reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5819program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5820This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5821interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5822
5823The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5824in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5825precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5826the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5827not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5828
5829The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5830generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5831ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5832
5833This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5834@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5835
5836@smallexample
5837@group
5838PHDRS
5839@{
5840 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5841 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5842@}
5843@end group
5844@end smallexample
5845
5846The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5847of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5848header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5849with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5850must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5851is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5852
5853Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5854system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5855specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5856sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5857attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5858Section Phdr}.
5859
5860It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5861merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5862repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5863contain the section.
5864
5865If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5866then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5867not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5868convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5869placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5870default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5871segment at all.
5872
5873@kindex FILEHDR
5874@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5875You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5876the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5877The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5878file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5879include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5880segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5881these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5882
5883The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5884value of the keyword.
5885
5886@table @asis
5887@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5888Indicates an unused program header.
5889
5890@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5891Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5892the file.
5893
5894@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5895Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5896
5897@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5898Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5899found.
5900
5901@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5902Indicates a segment holding note information.
5903
5904@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5905A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5906ABI.
5907
5908@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5909Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5910
1a9ccd70
NC
5911@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5912Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5913
252b5132
RH
5914@item @var{expression}
5915An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5916be used for types not defined above.
5917@end table
5918
5919You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5920in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5921@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5922Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5923output section attribute.
5924
5925The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5926which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5927explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5928an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5929header.
5930
5931Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5932headers used on a native ELF system.
5933
5934@example
5935@group
5936PHDRS
5937@{
5938 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5939 interp PT_INTERP ;
5940 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5941 data PT_LOAD ;
5942 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5943@}
5944
5945SECTIONS
5946@{
5947 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5948 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5949 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5950 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5951 @dots{}
5952 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5953 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5954 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5955 @dots{}
5956@}
5957@end group
5958@end example
5959
5960@node VERSION
5961@section VERSION Command
5962@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5963@cindex symbol versions
5964@cindex version script
5965@cindex versions of symbols
5966The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5967only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5968symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5969a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5970shared library.
5971
5972You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5973you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5974also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5975
5976The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5977@smallexample
5978VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5979@end smallexample
5980
5981The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5982Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5983version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5984version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5985version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5986scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5987library.
5988
5989The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5990examples.
5991
5992@smallexample
5993VERS_1.1 @{
5994 global:
5995 foo1;
5996 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5997 old*;
5998 original*;
5999 new*;
252b5132
RH
6000@};
6001
6002VERS_1.2 @{
6003 foo2;
6004@} VERS_1.1;
6005
6006VERS_2.0 @{
6007 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6008 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6009 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6010 "f(int, double)";
6011 @};
252b5132
RH
6012@} VERS_1.2;
6013@end smallexample
6014
6015This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6016version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6017The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6018a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6019of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6020symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6021is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6022in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6023However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6024name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6025
6026Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6027depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6028to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6029
6030Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6031depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6032and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6033
6034When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6035specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6036unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6037unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6038somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6039wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6040wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6041set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6042ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6043
6044The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6045they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6046could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6047However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6048
0f6bf451 6049Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6050in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6051symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6052won't.
6053
6054@smallexample
7c9c73be 6055@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6056@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6057
252b5132
RH
6058When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6059symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6060requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6061shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6062loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6063linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6064application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6065way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6066all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6067search for each symbol reference.
6068
6069The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6070doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6071that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6072functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6073the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6074required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6075that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6076versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6077the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6078
6079There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6080first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6081source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6082script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6083maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6084@smallexample
6085__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6086@end smallexample
6087@noindent
6088in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6089be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6090The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6091@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6092takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6093
6094The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6095function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6096an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6097version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6098linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6099
6100To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6101source file. Here is an example:
6102
6103@smallexample
6104__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6105__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6106__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6107__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6108@end smallexample
6109
6110In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6111unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6112example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6113@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6114
6115When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6116some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6117this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6118@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6119declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6120you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6121
6122If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6123within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6124(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6125specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6126
cb840a31
L
6127You can also specify the language in the version script:
6128
6129@smallexample
6130VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6131@end smallexample
6132
c0065db7 6133The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6134The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6135demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6136patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6137@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6138
86043bbb
MM
6139Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6140described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6141or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6142the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6143whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6144cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6145might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6146should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6147expect when you upgrade.
6148
252b5132
RH
6149@node Expressions
6150@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6151@cindex expressions
6152@cindex arithmetic
6153The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6154that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6155expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6156host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6157
6158You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6159
6160The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6161expressions.
6162
6163@menu
6164* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6165* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6166* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6167* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6168* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6169* Operators:: Operators
6170* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6171* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6172* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6173@end menu
6174
6175@node Constants
6176@subsection Constants
6177@cindex integer notation
6178@cindex constants in linker scripts
6179All constants are integers.
6180
6181As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6182octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6183hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6184@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6185@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6186value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6187
6188@cindex scaled integers
6189@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6190@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6191@cindex suffixes for integers
6192@cindex integer suffixes
6193In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6194constant by
6195@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6196@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6197@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6198@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6199@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6200@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6201@tex
6202${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6203@end tex
6204@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6205respectively. For example, the following
6206all refer to the same quantity:
6207
252b5132 6208@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6209_fourk_1 = 4K;
6210_fourk_2 = 4096;
6211_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6212_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6213@end smallexample
6214
8a308ae8
NC
6215Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6216conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6217
0c71d759
NC
6218@node Symbolic Constants
6219@subsection Symbolic Constants
6220@cindex symbolic constants
6221@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6222It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6223the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6224
6225@table @code
6226@item MAXPAGESIZE
6227@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6228The target's maximum page size.
6229
6230@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6231@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6232The target's default page size.
6233@end table
6234
6235So for example:
6236
6237@smallexample
9d5777a3 6238 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6239@end smallexample
6240
6241will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6242supported by the target.
6243
252b5132
RH
6244@node Symbols
6245@subsection Symbol Names
6246@cindex symbol names
6247@cindex names
6248@cindex quoted symbol names
6249@kindex "
6250Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6251and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6252Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6253specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6254keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6255@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6256"SECTION" = 9;
6257"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6258@end smallexample
6259
6260Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6261to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6262whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6263
ecca9871
L
6264@node Orphan Sections
6265@subsection Orphan Sections
6266@cindex orphan
6267Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6268are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6269script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6270output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6271in which to place the orphaned input section.
6272
6273If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6274an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6275placed at the end of that output section.
6276
6277If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6278sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6279name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6280orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6281one new output section.
6282
6283If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6284then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6285in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6286linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6287attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6288sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6289support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6290
a05a5b64
TP
6291The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6292(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6293output sections an orphan is placed in.
6294
252b5132
RH
6295@node Location Counter
6296@subsection The Location Counter
6297@kindex .
6298@cindex dot
6299@cindex location counter
6300@cindex current output location
6301The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6302current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6303location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6304within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6305anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6306
6307@cindex holes
6308Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6309moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6310location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6311and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6312doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6313
6314@smallexample
6315SECTIONS
6316@{
6317 output :
6318 @{
6319 file1(.text)
6320 . = . + 1000;
6321 file2(.text)
6322 . += 1000;
6323 file3(.text)
563e308f 6324 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6325@}
6326@end smallexample
6327@noindent
6328In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6329located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6330followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6331@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6332@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6333specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6334
5c6bbab8
NC
6335@cindex dot inside sections
6336Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6337current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6338statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6339absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6340however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6341not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6342
6343@smallexample
6344SECTIONS
6345@{
6346 . = 0x100
6347 .text: @{
6348 *(.text)
6349 . = 0x200
6350 @}
6351 . = 0x500
6352 .data: @{
6353 *(.data)
6354 . += 0x600
6355 @}
6356@}
6357@end smallexample
6358
6359The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6360and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6361the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6362much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6363move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6364and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6365the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6366the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6367
b5666f2f
AM
6368@cindex dot outside sections
6369Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6370output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6371needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6372
6373@smallexample
6374SECTIONS
6375@{
6376 start_of_text = . ;
6377 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6378 end_of_text = . ;
6379
6380 start_of_data = . ;
6381 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6382 end_of_data = . ;
6383@}
6384@end smallexample
6385
6386If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6387not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6388between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6389should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6390blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6391the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6392sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6393statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6394special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6395place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6396as follows:
6397
6398@smallexample
6399SECTIONS
6400@{
6401 start_of_text = . ;
6402 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6403 end_of_text = . ;
6404
6405 start_of_data = . ;
6406 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6407 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6408 end_of_data = . ;
6409@}
6410@end smallexample
6411
6412This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6413@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6414placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6415assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6416a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6417section. So you could write:
6418
6419@smallexample
6420SECTIONS
6421@{
6422 start_of_text = . ;
6423 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6424 end_of_text = . ;
6425
6426 . = . ;
6427 start_of_data = . ;
6428 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6429 end_of_data = . ;
6430@}
6431@end smallexample
6432
6433Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6434@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6435
252b5132
RH
6436@need 2000
6437@node Operators
6438@subsection Operators
6439@cindex operators for arithmetic
6440@cindex arithmetic operators
6441@cindex precedence in expressions
6442The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6443the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6444@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6445@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6446@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6447@smallexample
6448precedence associativity Operators Notes
6449(highest)
64501 left ! - ~ (1)
64512 left * / %
64523 left + -
64534 left >> <<
64545 left == != > < <= >=
64556 left &
64567 left |
64578 left &&
64589 left ||
645910 right ? :
646011 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6461(lowest)
6462@end smallexample
6463Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6464(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6465(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6466@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6467@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6468@tex
6469\vskip \baselineskip
6470%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6471\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6472\hrule
6473\halign
6474{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6475height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6476&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6477height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6478\noalign{\hrule}
6479height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6480&highest&&&&&\cr
6481% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6482&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6483&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6484&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6485&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6486&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6487&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6488&7&&left&&|&\cr
6489&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6490&9&&left&&||&\cr
6491&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6492&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6493&lowest&&&&&\cr
6494height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6495\hrule}
6496@end tex
6497@iftex
6498{
6499@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6500@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6501@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6502}
6503@end iftex
6504@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6505
6506@node Evaluation
6507@subsection Evaluation
6508@cindex lazy evaluation
6509@cindex expression evaluation order
6510The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6511an expression when absolutely necessary.
6512
6513The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6514address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6515regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6516as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6517
6518However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6519until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6520other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6521for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6522
6523The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6524assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6525allocation.
6526
6527Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6528@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6529
6530If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6531available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6532following
6533@smallexample
6534@group
6535SECTIONS
6536 @{
a1ab1d2a 6537 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6538 @{ *(.text) @}
6539 @}
6540@end group
6541@end smallexample
6542@noindent
6543will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6544address}.
6545
6546@node Expression Section
6547@subsection The Section of an Expression
6548@cindex expression sections
6549@cindex absolute expressions
6550@cindex relative expressions
6551@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6552@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6553@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6554Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6555relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6556using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6557value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6558symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6559operations.
6560
abf4be64
AM
6561Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6562section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6563address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6564@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6565functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6566One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6567(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6568differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6569versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6570section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6571Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6572absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6573given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6574everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6575
6576In the following simple example,
252b5132 6577
7542af2a
AM
6578@smallexample
6579@group
6580SECTIONS
6581 @{
6582 . = 0x100;
6583 __executable_start = 0x100;
6584 .data :
6585 @{
6586 . = 0x10;
6587 __data_start = 0x10;
6588 *(.data)
6589 @}
6590 @dots{}
6591 @}
6592@end group
6593@end smallexample
252b5132 6594
7542af2a
AM
6595both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6596address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6597@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6598section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6599
5c3049d2
AM
6600For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6601addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6602
6603@itemize @bullet
6604@item
c05f749e
AM
6605Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6606operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6607absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6608@item
7542af2a
AM
6609Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6610relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6611and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6612@item
c05f749e
AM
6613Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6614in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6615address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6616before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6617@end itemize
6618
6619The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6620
6621@itemize @bullet
6622@item
6623An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6624@item
6625The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6626@item
9bc8bb33 6627The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6628relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6629(after above conversions) is also a number when
6630@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6631but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6632@item
6633The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6634relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6635section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6636@item
6637The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6638conversions) is an absolute address.
6639@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6640
6641You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6642to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6643create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6644section @samp{.data}:
6645@smallexample
6646SECTIONS
6647 @{
6648 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6649 @}
6650@end smallexample
6651@noindent
6652If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6653@samp{.data} section.
6654
7542af2a
AM
6655Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6656particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6657
252b5132
RH
6658@node Builtin Functions
6659@subsection Builtin Functions
6660@cindex functions in expressions
6661The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6662use in linker script expressions.
6663
6664@table @code
6665@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6666@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6667@cindex expression, absolute
6668Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6669of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6670value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6671normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6672
6673@item ADDR(@var{section})
6674@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6675@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6676Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6677script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6678the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6679@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6680@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6681the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6682@smallexample
6683@group
6684SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6685 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6686 @{
252b5132
RH
6687 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6688 @dots{}
6689 @}
6690 .output :
6691 @{
6692 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6693 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6694 @}
6695@dots{} @}
6696@end group
6697@end smallexample
6698
876f4090
NS
6699@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6700@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6701@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6702@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6703@cindex round up location counter
6704@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6705@cindex round up expression
6706@cindex align expression
6707Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6708to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6709doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6710arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6711expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6712equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6713
6714Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6715next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6716variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6717input sections:
252b5132
RH
6718@smallexample
6719@group
6720SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6721 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6722 *(.data)
6723 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6724 @}
6725@dots{} @}
6726@end group
6727@end smallexample
6728@noindent
6729The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6730a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6731a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6732of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6733
6734The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6735
362c1d1a
NS
6736@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6737@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6738@cindex section alignment
6739Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6740been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6741evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6742the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6743value in that section.
6744@smallexample
6745@group
6746SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6747 .output @{
6748 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6749 @dots{}
6750 @}
6751@dots{} @}
6752@end group
6753@end smallexample
6754
252b5132
RH
6755@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6756@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6757This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6758scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6759section.
6760
2d20f7bf
JJ
6761@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6762@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6763This is equivalent to either
6764@smallexample
6765(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6766@end smallexample
6767or
6768@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6769(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6770 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6771@end smallexample
6772@noindent
6773depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6774for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6775@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6776If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6777memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6778bytes in the on-disk file.
6779
6780This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6781any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6782@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6783be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6784running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6785that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6786page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6787
6788@noindent
6789Example:
6790@smallexample
6791 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6792@end smallexample
6793
6794@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6795@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6796This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6797evaluation purposes.
6798
6799@smallexample
6800 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6801@end smallexample
6802
a4f5ad88
JJ
6803@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6804@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6805This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6806@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6807When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6808does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6809@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6810argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6811script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6812@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6813padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6814section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6815
6816@smallexample
6817 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6818@end smallexample
6819
252b5132
RH
6820@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6821@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6822@cindex symbol defaults
6823Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6824defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6825return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6826default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6827shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6828the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6829existed, its value is preserved:
6830
6831@smallexample
6832@group
6833SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6834 .text : @{
6835 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6836 @dots{}
6837 @}
6838 @dots{}
6839@}
6840@end group
6841@end smallexample
6842
3ec57632
NC
6843@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6844@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6845Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6846
252b5132
RH
6847@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6848@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6849@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6850Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6851Section LMA}).
6852
2e53f7d6
NC
6853@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6854@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6855Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6856@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6857
252b5132
RH
6858@kindex MAX
6859@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6860Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6861
6862@kindex MIN
6863@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6864Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6865
6866@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6867@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6868@cindex unallocated address, next
6869Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6870This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6871use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6872output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6873
3ec57632
NC
6874@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6875@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6876Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6877
ba916c8a
MM
6878@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6879@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6880Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6881value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6882@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6883will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6884can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6885``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6886name.
6887
252b5132
RH
6888@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6889@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6890@cindex section size
6891Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6892been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6893evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6894@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6895@smallexample
6896@group
6897SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6898 .output @{
6899 .start = . ;
6900 @dots{}
6901 .end = . ;
6902 @}
6903 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6904 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6905@dots{} @}
6906@end group
6907@end smallexample
6908
6909@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6910@itemx sizeof_headers
6911@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6912@cindex header size
6913Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6914information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6915this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6916choose, to facilitate paging.
6917
6918@cindex not enough room for program headers
6919@cindex program headers, not enough room
6920When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6921@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6922number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6923addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6924additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6925room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6926the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6927script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6928you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6929command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6930@end table
6931
6932@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6933@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6934@cindex implicit linker scripts
6935If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6936an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6937linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6938linker will report an error.
6939
6940An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6941
6942Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6943assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6944commands.
6945
6946Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6947at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6948read. This can affect archive searching.
6949
6950@ifset GENERIC
6951@node Machine Dependent
6952@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6953
6954@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6955@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6956sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6957functionality are not listed.
6958
6959@menu
36f63dca
NC
6960@ifset H8300
6961* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6962@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6963@ifset M68HC11
6964* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6965@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6966@ifset ARM
6967* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6968@end ifset
6969@ifset HPPA
6970* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6971@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6972@ifset M68K
6973* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6974@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6975@ifset MIPS
6976* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6977@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6978@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6979* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6980@end ifset
2469cfa2 6981@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6982* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6983@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6984@ifset NDS32
6985* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6986@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6987@ifset NIOSII
6988* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6989@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6990@ifset POWERPC
6991* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6992@end ifset
6993@ifset POWERPC64
6994* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6995@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6996@ifset S/390
6997* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6998@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6999@ifset SPU
7000* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7001@end ifset
74459f0e 7002@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7003* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7004@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7005@ifset WIN32
7006* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7007@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7008@ifset XTENSA
7009* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7010@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7011@end menu
7012@end ifset
7013
252b5132
RH
7014@ifset H8300
7015@ifclear GENERIC
7016@raisesections
7017@end ifclear
7018
7019@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7020@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7021
7022@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7023For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7024you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7025
7026@table @emph
7027@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7028@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7029@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7030targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7031program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7032respectively.
7033
7034@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7035@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7036@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7037@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7038sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7039page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7040(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7041@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7042top page of memory).
1502569c 7043
81f5558e
NC
7044@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7045indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7046displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7047the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7048@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7049whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7050range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7051
1502569c 7052@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7053@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7054biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7055which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7056page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7057(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7058@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7059the top page of memory).
7060
7061@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7062@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
706332 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7064changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7065(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7066@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7067the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7068@end table
7069
7070@ifclear GENERIC
7071@lowersections
7072@end ifclear
7073@end ifset
7074
36f63dca 7075@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7076@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7077@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7078@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7079@node Renesas
7080@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7081
c2dcd04e
NC
7082@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7083H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7084options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7085@end ifset
7086@end ifclear
7087
36f63dca
NC
7088@ifset ARM
7089@ifclear GENERIC
7090@raisesections
7091@end ifclear
7092
93fd0973
SC
7093@ifset M68HC11
7094@ifclear GENERIC
7095@raisesections
7096@end ifclear
7097
7098@node M68HC11/68HC12
7099@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7100
7101@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7102
7103@subsection Linker Relaxation
7104
7105For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7106optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7107
7108@table @emph
7109@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7110@item relaxing address modes
7111@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7112targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7113program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7114respectively.
7115
7116@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7117transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7118page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7119
7120@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7121When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7122of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7123addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7124@code{bset} instructions.
7125
7126@end table
7127
7128@subsection Trampoline Generation
7129
7130@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7131@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7132For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7133call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7134will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7135trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7136case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7137point to the function trampoline.
7138
7139@ifclear GENERIC
7140@lowersections
7141@end ifclear
7142@end ifset
7143
36f63dca 7144@node ARM
3674e28a 7145@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7146
7147@cindex ARM interworking support
7148@kindex --support-old-code
7149For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7150between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7151been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7152line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7153libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7154option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7155given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7156which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7157the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7158non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7159
7160@cindex thumb entry point
7161@cindex entry point, thumb
7162@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7163The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7164@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7165But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7166branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7167executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7168
ce11ba6c
KT
7169@cindex PE import table prefixing
7170@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7171The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7172the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7173element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7174import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7175
e489d0ae
PB
7176@cindex BE8
7177@kindex --be8
7178The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7179executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7180objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7181option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7182little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7183
3674e28a
PB
7184@cindex TARGET1
7185@kindex --target1-rel
7186@kindex --target1-abs
7187The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7188@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7189or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7190and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7191
7192@cindex TARGET2
7193@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7194The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7195@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7196meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7197@table @samp
7198@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7199@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7200@item abs
7201@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7202@item got-rel
7203@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7204@end table
7205
319850b4
JB
7206@cindex FIX_V4BX
7207@kindex --fix-v4bx
7208The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7209specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7210interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7211also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7212
7213In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7214linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7215@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7216
7217In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7218relocations are ignored.
7219
845b51d6
PB
7220@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7221@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7222Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7223relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7224
7225@smallexample
7226TST rM, #1
7227MOVEQ PC, rM
7228BX Rn
7229@end smallexample
7230
7231This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7232and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7233condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7234
33bfe774
JB
7235@cindex USE_BLX
7236@kindex --use-blx
7237The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7238BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7239situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7240code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7241each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7242
7243This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7244specify it if you are using that target.
7245
c6dd86c6
JB
7246@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7247@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7248The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7249bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7250instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7251to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7252the support code can read the intended values.
7253
7254The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7255intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7256and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7257intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7258full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7259you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7260
7261If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7262enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7263@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7264mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7265vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7266@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7267
7268If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7269potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7270such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7271first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7272instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7273the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7274are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7275
2de70689
MGD
7276@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7277@kindex --fix-arm1176
7278@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7279The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7280in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7281are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7282unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7283
9d5777a3 7284Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7285Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7286http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7287
a504d23a
LA
7288@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7289@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7290
7291The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7292workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7293the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7294off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7295the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7296core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7297integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7298VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7299
7300The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7301necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7302
7303The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7304@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7305STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7306linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7307@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7308
7309If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7310potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7311such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7312replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7313branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7314then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7315
7316The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7317the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7318
7319The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7320they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7321there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7322occurs.
7323
7324The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7325PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7326large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7327cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7328occurs.
7329
bf21ed78
MS
7330@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7331@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7332The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7333warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7334enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7335linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7336using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7337not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7338
7339@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7340@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7341The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7342warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7343@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7344linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7345using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7346
726150b7
NC
7347@cindex PIC_VENEER
7348@kindex --pic-veneer
7349The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7350ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7351is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7352@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7353
7354@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7355@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7356The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7357code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7358perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7359placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7360controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7361The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7362duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7363group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7364code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7365where they should be placed.
7366
7367The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7368@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7369placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7370branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7371placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7372value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7373exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7374A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7375linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7376from the input sections.
7377
7378The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7379@samp{N = +1}.
7380
1a51c1a4
NC
7381Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7382only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7383otherwise.
7384
1db37fe6
YG
7385@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7386@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7387@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7388The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7389
7390The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7391
68fcca92
JW
7392@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7393@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7394@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7395The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7396
7397Please contact ARM for further details.
7398
1db37fe6
YG
7399@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7400@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7401@cindex Merging exidx entries
7402The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7403
7404@kindex --long-plt
7405@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7406The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7407which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7408entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7409
1f56df9d
JW
7410@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7411@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7412The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7413link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7414
4ba2ef8f
TP
7415@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7416All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7417Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7418@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7419veneers in memory.
7420
54ddd295
TP
7421@kindex --cmse-implib
7422@cindex Secure gateway import library
7423The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7424specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7425secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7426executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7427
0955507f
TP
7428@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7429@cindex Input import library
7430The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7431must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7432given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7433in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7434@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7435library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7436library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7437for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7438specified.
7439
36f63dca
NC
7440@ifclear GENERIC
7441@lowersections
7442@end ifclear
7443@end ifset
7444
7445@ifset HPPA
7446@ifclear GENERIC
7447@raisesections
7448@end ifclear
7449
7450@node HPPA ELF32
7451@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7452@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7453@kindex --multi-subspace
7454When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7455import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7456The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7457stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7458multiple sub-spaces.
7459
7460@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7461@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7462Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7463stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7464@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7465sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7466a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7467the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7468conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7469prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7470A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7471branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7472@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7473@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7474detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7475positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7476
7477Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7478single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7479create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7480large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7481
7482@ifclear GENERIC
7483@lowersections
7484@end ifclear
7485@end ifset
7486
7fb9f789
NC
7487@ifset M68K
7488@ifclear GENERIC
7489@raisesections
7490@end ifclear
7491
7492@node M68K
7493@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7494
7495@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7496@kindex --got=@var{type}
7497The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7498The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7499@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7500the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7501@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7502entries only at non-negative offsets.
7503@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7504entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7505support such GOTs.
7506@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7507output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7508file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7509files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7510
7511@ifclear GENERIC
7512@lowersections
7513@end ifclear
7514@end ifset
7515
833794fc
MR
7516@ifset MIPS
7517@ifclear GENERIC
7518@raisesections
7519@end ifclear
7520
7521@node MIPS
7522@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7523
7524@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7525@kindex --insn32
7526@kindex --no-insn32
7527The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7528microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7529in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7530used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7531or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7532including 16-bit ones where possible.
7533
8b10b0b3
MR
7534@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7535@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7536@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7537The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7538control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7539@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7540relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7541calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7542relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7543instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7544or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7545the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7546
833794fc
MR
7547@ifclear GENERIC
7548@lowersections
7549@end ifclear
7550@end ifset
7551
36f63dca
NC
7552@ifset MMIX
7553@ifclear GENERIC
7554@raisesections
7555@end ifclear
7556
7557@node MMIX
7558@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7559For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7560@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7561understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7562can translate between the two formats.
7563
7564There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7565Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7566registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7567equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7568@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7569global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7570this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7571symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7572
7a2de473
HPN
7573Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7574@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7575The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7576of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7577
7578Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7579are left out from an mmo file.
7580
7581@ifclear GENERIC
7582@lowersections
7583@end ifclear
7584@end ifset
7585
7586@ifset MSP430
7587@ifclear GENERIC
7588@raisesections
7589@end ifclear
7590
7591@node MSP430
7592@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7593For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7594will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7595just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7596
7597@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7598The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7599
7600@table @code
7601@item @samp{.vectors}
7602Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7603
7604@item @samp{.bootloader}
7605Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7606in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7607
7608@item @samp{.infomem}
7609Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7610this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7611
c0065db7 7612@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7613This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7614in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7615
7616@item @samp{.noinit}
7617Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7618
c0065db7 7619The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7620@end table
7621
7ef3addb
JL
7622@table @option
7623@cindex MSP430 Options
7624@kindex --code-region
7625@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7626This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7627argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7628using this option.
7629
7630@kindex --data-region
7631@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7632This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7633[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7634for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7635
7636@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7637@item --disable-sec-transformation
7638Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7639and @code{--data-region} options.
7640This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7641wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7642not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7643@end table
7644
36f63dca
NC
7645@ifclear GENERIC
7646@lowersections
7647@end ifclear
7648@end ifset
7649
35c08157
KLC
7650@ifset NDS32
7651@ifclear GENERIC
7652@raisesections
7653@end ifclear
7654
7655@node NDS32
7656@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7657@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7658For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7659relaxes objects according to these options.
7660
7661@table @code
7662@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7663Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7664
7665@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7666Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7667
7668@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7669Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7670
7671@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7672Export the EX9 table after linking.
7673
7674@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7675Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7676
7677@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7678Update the existing EX9 table.
7679
7680@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7681Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7682
7683@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7684Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7685
7686@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7687Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7688
7689@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7690Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7691@end table
7692
7693@ifclear GENERIC
7694@lowersections
7695@end ifclear
7696@end ifset
7697
78058a5e
SL
7698@ifset NIOSII
7699@ifclear GENERIC
7700@raisesections
7701@end ifclear
7702
7703@node Nios II
7704@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7705@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7706@kindex --relax on Nios II
7707
7708Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7709transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7710which may result in @command{ld} giving
7711@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7712The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7713trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7714outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7715trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7716be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7717larger than 256MB.
7718
7719The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7720is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7721@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7722locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7723source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7724register as a temporary.
7725
7726Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7727relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7728option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7729
7730@ifclear GENERIC
7731@lowersections
7732@end ifclear
7733@end ifset
7734
2a60a7a8
AM
7735@ifset POWERPC
7736@ifclear GENERIC
7737@raisesections
7738@end ifclear
7739
7740@node PowerPC ELF32
7741@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7742@cindex PowerPC long branches
7743@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7744Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7745displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7746@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7747@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7748the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7749section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7750section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7751@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7752both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7753considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7754
7755@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7756@table @option
7757@cindex PowerPC PLT
7758@kindex --bss-plt
7759@item --bss-plt
7760Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7761generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7762the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7763writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7764@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7765PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7766compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7767BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7768
016687f8
AM
7769@kindex --secure-plt
7770@item --secure-plt
7771@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7772@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7773when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7774layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7775style BSS PLT.
7776
2a60a7a8
AM
7777@cindex PowerPC GOT
7778@kindex --sdata-got
7779@item --sdata-got
7780The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7781sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7782@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7783section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7784@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7785@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7786@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7787@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7788PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7789pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7790GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7791really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7792
7793@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7794@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7795@item --emit-stub-syms
7796This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7797symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7798
7799@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7800@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7801@item --no-tls-optimize
7802PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7803sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7804disable the optimization.
7805@end table
7806
7807@ifclear GENERIC
7808@lowersections
7809@end ifclear
7810@end ifset
7811
7812@ifset POWERPC64
7813@ifclear GENERIC
7814@raisesections
7815@end ifclear
7816
7817@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7818@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7819
7820@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7821@table @option
7822@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7823@kindex --stub-group-size
7824@item --stub-group-size
7825Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7826by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7827@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7828sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7829a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7830the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7831conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7832prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7833A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7834branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7835@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7836@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7837detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7838positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7839
7840Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7841single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7842create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7843large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7844
7845@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7846@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7847@item --emit-stub-syms
7848This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7849symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7850
7851@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7852@kindex --dotsyms
7853@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7854@item --dotsyms
7855@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7856These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7857in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7858function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7859code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7860properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7861to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7862@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7863dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7864feature.
7865
7ae4ea7d
AM
7866@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7867@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7868@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7869@item --save-restore-funcs
7870@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7871These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7872provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7873@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7874function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7875link.
7876
2a60a7a8
AM
7877@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7878@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7879@item --no-tls-optimize
7880PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7881sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7882disable the optimization.
7883
7c9cf415
AM
7884@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7885@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7886@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7887@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7888@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7889@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7890@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7891These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7892stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7893an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7894@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7895stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7896generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7897__tls_get_addr_opt.
7898Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7899much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7900an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7901will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7902@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7903and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7904this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7905Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7906@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7907register saves.
7c9cf415 7908
2a60a7a8
AM
7909@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7910@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7911@item --no-opd-optimize
7912PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7913corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7914the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7915Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7916
7917@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7918@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7919@item --non-overlapping-opd
7920Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7921@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7922the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7923entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7924
7925@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7926@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7927@item --no-toc-optimize
7928PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7929entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7930reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7931marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7932marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7933relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7934unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7935reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7936discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7937reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7938code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7939optimization.
7940
d882c988
AM
7941@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7942@kindex --no-inline-optimize
7943@item --no-inline-optimize
7944PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7945marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7946@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7947a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7948locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7949disables that optimization.
7950
2a60a7a8
AM
7951@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7952@kindex --no-multi-toc
7953@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7954If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7955@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7956where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7957entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7958total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7959grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7960TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7961calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7962help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
796364K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7964Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7965
7966@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7967@kindex --no-toc-sort
7968@item --no-toc-sort
7969By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7970happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7971placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7972with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7973referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7974@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7975results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7976off this feature.
7977
7978@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7979@kindex --plt-align
7980@kindex --no-plt-align
7981@item --plt-align
7982@itemx --no-plt-align
7983Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7984aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7985boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7986specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7987specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7988if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7989PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7990
7991@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7992@kindex --plt-static-chain
7993@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7994@item --plt-static-chain
7995@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7996Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7997chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7998chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7999
8000@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8001@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8002@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8003@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8004@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8005With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8006lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8007another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8008order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8009memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8010barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8011looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8012seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8013default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8014
8015@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8016@kindex --plt-localentry
8017@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8018@item --plt-localentry
8019@itemx --no-localentry
8020ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8021ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8022(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8023Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8024or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8025functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8026in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8027interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8028including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8029to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8030complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8031care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8032
8033@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8034@kindex --power10-stubs
8035@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8036@item --power10-stubs
8037@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8038When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8039relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8040linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8041for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8042power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8043power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8044allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8045@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8046auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8047@end table
8048
8049@ifclear GENERIC
8050@lowersections
8051@end ifclear
8052@end ifset
8053
b4cbbe8f
AK
8054@ifset S/390
8055@ifclear GENERIC
8056@raisesections
8057@end ifclear
8058
8059@node S/390 ELF
8060@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8061
8062@cindex S/390 ELF options
8063@table @option
8064
8065@cindex S/390
8066@kindex --s390-pgste
8067@item --s390-pgste
8068This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8069segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8070binaries marked that way.
8071@end table
8072
8073@ifclear GENERIC
8074@lowersections
8075@end ifclear
8076@end ifset
8077
49fa1e15
AM
8078@ifset SPU
8079@ifclear GENERIC
8080@raisesections
8081@end ifclear
8082
8083@node SPU ELF
8084@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8085
8086@cindex SPU ELF options
8087@table @option
8088
8089@cindex SPU plugins
8090@kindex --plugin
8091@item --plugin
8092This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8093
8094@cindex SPU overlays
8095@kindex --no-overlays
8096@item --no-overlays
8097Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8098regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8099@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8100turns off all this special overlay handling.
8101
8102@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8103@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8104@item --emit-stub-syms
8105This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8106symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8107
8108@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8109@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8110@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8111This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8112function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8113on calls to non-overlay regions.
8114
8115@cindex SPU local store size
8116@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8117@item --local-store=lo:hi
8118@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8119the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8120range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8121
c0065db7 8122@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8123@kindex --stack-analysis
8124@item --stack-analysis
8125SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8126unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8127under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8128@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8129@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8130determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8131for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8132for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8133for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8134find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8135and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8136under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8137dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8138is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8139and calls will be given.
8140
c0065db7 8141@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8142@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8143@item --emit-stack-syms
8144This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8145in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8146These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8147functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8148functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8149such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8150The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8151@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8152@end table
8153
8154@ifclear GENERIC
8155@lowersections
8156@end ifclear
8157@end ifset
8158
36f63dca
NC
8159@ifset TICOFF
8160@ifclear GENERIC
8161@raisesections
8162@end ifclear
8163
8164@node TI COFF
8165@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8166@cindex TI COFF versions
8167@kindex --format=@var{version}
8168The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8169TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8170also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8171format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8172header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8173
8174@ifclear GENERIC
8175@lowersections
8176@end ifclear
8177@end ifset
8178
2ca22b03
NC
8179@ifset WIN32
8180@ifclear GENERIC
8181@raisesections
8182@end ifclear
8183
8184@node WIN32
8185@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8186
c0065db7 8187This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8188See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8189command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8190
8191@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8192@cindex import libraries
8193@item import libraries
69da35b5 8194The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8195libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8196regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8197archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8198support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8199@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8200
c0065db7
RM
8201@item exporting DLL symbols
8202@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8203The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8204
8205@table @emph
8206@item using auto-export functionality
8207@cindex using auto-export functionality
8208By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8209which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8210
0a5d968e
NC
8211@itemize
8212@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8213@item --exclude-symbols
8214@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8215@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8216@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8217@end itemize
8218
09e2aba4
DK
8219When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8220(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8221symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8222often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8223private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8224options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8225exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8226final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8227
8228If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8229command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8230if either of the following are true:
8231
8232@itemize
8233@item A DEF file is used.
8234@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8235@end itemize
dc8465bf 8236
c0065db7
RM
8237@item using a DEF file
8238@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8239Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8240an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8241exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8242name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8243command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8244
8245@example
8246gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8247@end example
8248
0a5d968e
NC
8249Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8250@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8251
dc8465bf
NC
8252Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8253
8254@example
4b5bd4e7 8255LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8256
8257EXPORTS
8258foo
8259bar
8260_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8261another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8262var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8263doo = foo == foo2
8264eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8265@end example
dc8465bf 8266
7fcab871 8267This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8268symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8269alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8270by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8271@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8272@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8273export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8274in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8275symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8276
6b31ad16
DS
8277The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8278name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8279the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8280
b45619c0
NC
8281When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8282library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8283@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8284executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8285
8286With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8287specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8288non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8289
8290If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8291or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8292filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8293
4b5bd4e7
DS
8294The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8295
8296@example
8297EXPORTS
8298 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8299 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8300 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8301@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8302
8303Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8304@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8305@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8306@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8307Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8308@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8309string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8310
8311The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8312
8313@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8314will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8315by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8316linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8317library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8318
8319@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8320The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8321the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8322@code{*_imp__foo}).
8323
8324@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8325well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8326read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8327variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8328the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8329extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8330application will behave unexpectedly.
8331
8332@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8333it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8334symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8335API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8336the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8337
4b5bd4e7
DS
8338See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8339other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8340
8341@cindex creating a DEF file
8342While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8343with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8344
8345@item Using decorations
8346@cindex Using decorations
8347Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8348itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8349declared as:
8350
8351@example
8352__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8353__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8354@end example
8355
8356All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8357any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8358this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8359the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8360
8361Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8362decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8363instead:
8364
8365@example
8366__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8367__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8368@end example
8369
c0065db7
RM
8370This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8371when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8372variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8373code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8374of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8375omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8376@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8377information.
c0065db7 8378@end table
dc8465bf 8379
2ca22b03
NC
8380@cindex automatic data imports
8381@item automatic data imports
8382The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8383by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8384compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8385issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8386code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8387c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8388initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8389decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8390platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8391command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8392The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8393suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8394trigger the feature's use.
8395
c0065db7 8396auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8397additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8398
c0065db7 8399"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8400documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8401
c0065db7
RM
8402The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8403occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8404One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8405below.
8406
8407@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8408For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8409object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8410offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8411field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8412in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8413without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8414The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8415references.
8416
c0065db7
RM
8417The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8418be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8419themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8420runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8421compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8422support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8423run without error on an older system.
8424
c0065db7
RM
8425@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8426enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8427
8428@cindex direct linking to a dll
8429@item direct linking to a dll
8430The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8431including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8432libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8433traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8434libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8435function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8436though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8437storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8438tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8439large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8440
c0065db7 8441Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8442@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8443of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8444perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8445select the dll instead of an import library.
8446
2ca22b03 8447
69da35b5
NC
8448For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8449to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8450
8451@example
45e948fe
NC
8452libxxx.dll.a
8453xxx.dll.a
8454libxxx.a
8455xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8456libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8457cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8458libxxx.dll
8459xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8460@end example
8461
69da35b5
NC
8462before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8463
c0065db7
RM
8464(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8465where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8466@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8467file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8468@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8469
c0065db7
RM
8470Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8471@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8472was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8473various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8474could coexist on the same machine.
8475
2ca22b03
NC
8476The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8477applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8478libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8479
8480@example
8481bin/
8482 cygxxx.dll
8483lib/
8484 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8485 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8486@end example
8487
c0065db7
RM
8488Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8489done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8490
84911. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8492@example
8493gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8494@end example
2ca22b03 8495
69da35b5
NC
8496However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8497(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8498@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8499not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8500
2ca22b03
NC
85012. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8502directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8503should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8504making the app/dll.
8505
8506@example
8507ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8508@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8509
8510Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8511
8512@example
8513gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8514@end example
69da35b5
NC
8515
8516This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8517perfectly legal
8518
8519@example
8520bin/
8521 cygxxx-5.dll
8522lib/
c0065db7 8523 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8524@end example
8525
dc8465bf 8526Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8527even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8528@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8529
8530Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8531wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8532
85331. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8534work with auto-imported data.
8535
dc8465bf
NC
85362. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8537import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8538symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8539for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8540possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8541
45e948fe
NC
85423. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8543critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8544in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8545stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8546
69da35b5 8547So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8548true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8549a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8550binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8551massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8552requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8553will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8554
c0065db7 8555@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8556@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8557@item adding additional names
8558Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8559A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8560exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8561when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8562import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8563
c0065db7 8564@example
dc8465bf
NC
8565LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8566
8567EXPORTS
c0065db7 8568foo
dc8465bf 8569_foo = foo
c0065db7 8570@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8571
8572The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8573
8574Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8575source code using the "weak" attribute:
8576
c0065db7
RM
8577@example
8578void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8579void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8580@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8581
8582See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8583symbols.
8584
8585@item renaming symbols
8586Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8587kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8588@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8589DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8590created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8591
c0065db7 8592@example
dc8465bf
NC
8593LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8594
8595EXPORTS
8596_foo = foo
c0065db7 8597@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8598
8599The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8600@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8601@end table
dc8465bf 8602
0a5d968e 8603Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8604unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8605If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8606@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8607that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8608@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8609renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8610to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8611the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8612In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8613which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8614
8615@cindex weak externals
8616@item weak externals
8617The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8618weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8619defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8620are three variants of weak externals:
8621@itemize
8622@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8623called lazy externals.
8624@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8625This form is not presently implemented.
8626@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8627implemented.
8628@end itemize
8629As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8630are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8631uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8632
8633@cindex aligned common symbols
8634@item aligned common symbols
8635As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8636desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8637the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8638carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8639by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8640tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8641but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8642warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8643
2ca22b03
NC
8644@end table
8645
8646@ifclear GENERIC
8647@lowersections
8648@end ifclear
8649@end ifset
8650
e0001a05
NC
8651@ifset XTENSA
8652@ifclear GENERIC
8653@raisesections
8654@end ifclear
8655
8656@node Xtensa
8657@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8658
8659@cindex Xtensa processors
8660The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8661@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8662specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8663keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8664example, with the command:
8665
8666@smallexample
8667SECTIONS
8668@{
8669 .text : @{
8670 *(.literal .text)
8671 @}
8672@}
8673@end smallexample
8674
8675@noindent
8676@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8677and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8678literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8679interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8680group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8681files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8682and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8683
43cd72b9 8684@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8685@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8686Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8687provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8688is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8689literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8690will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8691location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8692the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8693unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8694@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8695range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8696
8697For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8698to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8699instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8700instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8701instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8702@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8703hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8704By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8705switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8706density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8707instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8708performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8709linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8710a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8711
8712The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8713control the linker:
8714
8715@cindex Xtensa options
8716@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8717@item --size-opt
8718When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8719more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8720no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8721alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8722preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8723
8724@item --abi-windowed
8725@itemx --abi-call0
8726Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8727PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8728because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8729conventions.
8730Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8731of the first input object.
8732A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8733or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8734@end table
e0001a05
NC
8735
8736@ifclear GENERIC
8737@lowersections
8738@end ifclear
8739@end ifset
8740
252b5132
RH
8741@ifclear SingleFormat
8742@node BFD
8743@chapter BFD
8744
8745@cindex back end
8746@cindex object file management
8747@cindex object formats available
8748@kindex objdump -i
8749The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8750These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8751object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8752format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8753it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8754associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8755object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8756(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8757list all the formats available for your configuration.
8758
8759@cindex BFD requirements
8760@cindex requirements for BFD
8761As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8762several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8763BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8764formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8765been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8766BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8767may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8768
8769One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8770mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8771useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8772conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8773
8774@menu
8775* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8776@end menu
8777
8778@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8779@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8780@cindex opening object files
8781@include bfdsumm.texi
8782@end ifclear
8783
8784@node Reporting Bugs
8785@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8786@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8787@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8788
ff5dcc92 8789Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8790
8791Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8792it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8793to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8794work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8795@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8796
8797In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8798information that enables us to fix the bug.
8799
8800@menu
8801* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8802* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8803@end menu
8804
8805@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8806@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8807@cindex bug criteria
8808
8809If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8810
8811@itemize @bullet
8812@cindex fatal signal
8813@cindex linker crash
8814@cindex crash of linker
8815@item
8816If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8817@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8818
8819@cindex error on valid input
8820@item
ff5dcc92 8821If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8822
8823@cindex invalid input
8824@item
ff5dcc92 8825If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8826may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8827object files are correct.
8828
8829@item
8830If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8831improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8832@end itemize
8833
8834@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8835@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8836@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8837@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8838
8839A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8840products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8841recommend you contact that organization first.
8842
8843You can find contact information for many support companies and
8844individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8845distribution.
8846
ad22bfe8 8847@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8848Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8849@value{BUGURL}.
8850@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8851
8852The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8853@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8854fact or leave it out, state it!
8855
8856Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8857problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8858assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8859matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8860the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8861location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8862were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8863into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8864specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8865and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8866
8867Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8868the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8869on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8870
8871Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8872bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8873respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8874You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8875
8876To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8877
8878@itemize @bullet
8879@item
ff5dcc92 8880The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8881the @samp{--version} argument.
8882
8883Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8884the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8885
8886@item
ff5dcc92 8887Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8888patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8889
8890@item
8891The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8892version number.
8893
8894@item
ff5dcc92 8895What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8896``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8897
8898@item
8899The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8900observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8901list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8902sufficient.
8903
8904If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8905and then we might not encounter the bug.
8906
8907@item
8908A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8909bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8910provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8911bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8912state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8913requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8914we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8915attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8916
8917If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8918@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8919object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8920@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8921how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8922
8923@item
8924A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8925incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8926
ff5dcc92 8927Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8928will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8929not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8930a chance to make a mistake.
8931
8932Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8933say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8934copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8935C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8936and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8937fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8938you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8939any conclusion from our observations.
8940
8941@item
ff5dcc92 8942If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8943diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8944@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8945If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8946context, not by line number.
8947
8948The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8949sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8950@end itemize
8951
8952Here are some things that are not necessary:
8953
8954@itemize @bullet
8955@item
8956A description of the envelope of the bug.
8957
8958Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8959which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8960changes will not affect it.
8961
8962This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8963will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8964with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8965We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8966
8967Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8968of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8969output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8970less time, and so on.
8971
8972However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8973report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8974
8975@item
8976A patch for the bug.
8977
8978A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8979the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8980a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8981to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8982
ff5dcc92 8983Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8984construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8985through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8986able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8987fixed.
8988
8989And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8990patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8991help us to understand.
8992
8993@item
8994A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8995
8996Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8997things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8998@end itemize
8999
9000@node MRI
9001@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9002@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9003To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9004linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9005alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9006described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9007simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9008@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9009linker commands; these commands are described here.
9010
9011In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9012file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9013features to make use of them.
9014
9015You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9016@samp{-c} command-line option.
9017
9018Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9019command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9020blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9021MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9022issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9023
9024Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9025
9026You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9027lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9028The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9029
9030@table @code
9031@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9032@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9033@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9034Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9035the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9036@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9037your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9038script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9039commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9040input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9041@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9042
9043@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9044@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9045Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9046in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9047
9048@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9049
9050@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9051@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9052Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9053@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9054
9055@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9056@item BASE @var{expression}
9057Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9058absolute addresses) in the output file.
9059
9060@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9061@item CHIP @var{expression}
9062@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9063This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9064
9065@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9066@item END
9067This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9068
9069@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9070@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9071Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9072language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9073
9074@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9075@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9076Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9077@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9078
9079The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9080same line, with no change in its effect.
9081
9082@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9083@item LOAD @var{filename}
9084@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9085Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9086same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9087command line.
9088
9089@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9090@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9091@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9092MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9093option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9094
9095@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9096@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9097@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9098Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9099order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9100script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9101sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9102file, in the order specified.
9103
9104@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9105@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9106@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9107@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9108Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9109@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9110
9111@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9112@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9113@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9114@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9115You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9116specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9117If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9118@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9119@end table
9120
793c5807
NC
9121@node GNU Free Documentation License
9122@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9123@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9124
370b66a1
CD
9125@node LD Index
9126@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9127
9128@printindex cp
9129
9130@tex
7ca01ed9 9131% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9132% meantime:
9133\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9134\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9135\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9136\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9137\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9138\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9139\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9140\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9141\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9142% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9143@end tex
9144
252b5132 9145@bye